Hitachi DZ BX31A User Manual

Instruction Manual  
DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
DVD-RAM DVD-RW DVD-R  
DZ-BX31A  
DZ-GX20MA  
DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA  
Instruction manual  
Manual de instrucciones  
Toobtainthebest performanceandensureyearsof  
trouble-free use, please read this instruction  
manual completely.  
Para obtener el mejor funcionamiento y asegurar  
muchos años de utilización exentade problemas,  
lea todo este manual de instrucciones.  
Mode d’emploi  
Des performances optimales et un fonctionnement  
à long terme seront assurés en appliquant les  
présentes instructions après avoir entièrement lu  
ce mode d’emploi.  
Warning: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following  
two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept  
any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable  
protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses,  
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the  
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no  
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the  
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct by one or more of the following  
measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is  
connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Caution to the user: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
®
®
®
®
®
Microsoft , Windows , Windows Me, Windows 2000 Professional, and Windows XP are  
registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.  
®
®
®
Intel , Pentium Processor, and Celeron Processor are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation.  
IBM and PC/AT are registered trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
®
®
“Dolby” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.  
Other company names and product names listed are trademarks or brand names belonging to each  
individual company.  
SD logo is a trademark.  
3
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
In addition to the careful attention devoted to quality standards in the manufacture of your video product, safety is a  
major factor in the design of every instrument. But, safety is your responsibility too.  
This page lists important information that will help to assure your enjoyment and proper use of DVD video camera/  
recorder and accessory equipment.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Read these instructions.  
Keep these instructions.  
Heed all warnings.  
Follow all instructions.  
Do not use this apparatus near water.  
Clean only with dry cloth.  
Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in  
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.  
8
9
Do not install near any heat sources such as  
radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus  
(including amplifiers) that produce heat.  
Protect the power cord from being walked on or  
pinched particularly at plugs, convenience  
receptacles, and the point where they exit from the  
apparatus.  
10 Only use attachments/accessories specified by the  
manufacturer.  
11 Use only with the cart, stand,  
tripod, bracket, or table specified  
by the manufacturer, or sold with  
the apparatus. When a cart is  
used, use caution when moving  
the cart/apparatus combination to  
avoid injury from tip-over.  
12 Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or  
when unused for long periods of time.  
13 Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.  
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been  
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or  
plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects  
have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has  
been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate  
normally, or has been dropped.  
14 The apparatus shall not be exposed to dripping or  
splashing and that no objects filled with liquids,  
such as vases, shall be placed on the apparatus.  
15 The equipment (AC Adapter/Charger) shall be  
used near the socket-outlet and shall be easily  
accessible.  
4
Cautions When Using  
Handle the liquid crystal display (LCD) with care:  
The LCD is a very delicate display device: Do not press its surface with force, hit it or prick it with  
a sharp object.  
If you push the LCD surface, unevenness in display may occur. If unevenness does not disappear  
soon, turn the DVD video camera/recorder off, wait for a few moments, and then turn it on again.  
Do not place the DVD video camera/recorder with the open LCD screen down.  
Close the LCD monitor when not using the DVD video camera/recorder.  
Liquid crystal display (LCD) and viewfinder:  
The LCD screen and viewfinder are the products of highly precise technology. Among the total  
number of pixels (approx. 120,000 pixels for LCD monitor and equivalent to approx. 200,000 pixels  
for viewfinder), 0.01% or less pixels may be missing (black dots) or may remain lit as colored dots  
(red, blue, green). This shows the limitations of the current technology, and does not indicate a  
fault that will interfere with recording.  
The LCD screen and viewfinder will be slightly dimmer than usual when the DVD video camera/  
recorder is at low temperature, as in cold areas, or immediately after power is turned on. Normal  
brightness will be restored when the temperature inside the DVD video camera/recorder rises.  
Hold the DVD video camera/recorder correctly:  
Do not hold the viewfinder or LCD monitor when lifting the DVD video camera/recorder: The  
viewfinder or LCD monitor could detach and the DVD video camera/recorder may fall.  
Do not subject the DVD video camera/recorder to impact:  
This DVD video camera/recorder is a precision machine. Take great care that you do not strike it  
against a hard object or let it fall.  
When using a tripod, firmly secure the DVD video camera/recorder on it. Do not use the DVD  
video camera/recorder with a tripod in a place where it is subject to severe vibrations or impact.  
No sand or dust!  
Fine sand or dust entering the DVD video camera/recorder or AC adapter/charger could cause  
malfunctions or defects.  
No water or oil!  
Water or oil entering the DVD video camera/recorder or AC adapter/charger could cause electric  
shock, malfunctions or defects.  
5
Heat on surface of product:  
The surfaces of the DVD video camera/recorder, AC adapter/charger and battery will be slightly  
warm, but this does not indicate a fault.  
Screen on connected TV:  
Never leave the disc navigation screen, still image or camera image displayed on your TV to which  
the DVD video camera/recorder is connected: Doing so could result in displayed image retention  
or phosphor degradation of TV screen.  
Be careful of ambient temperature:  
Using the DVD video camera/recorder in a place where the temperature is over 104ºF (40ºC) or  
under 32ºF (0ºC) will result in abnormal recording/playback.  
Take care that the temperature of this DVD video camera/recorder, when connected to PC does  
not rise excessively (reference for usage: approx. 30 minutes at about 86ºF (30ºC)).  
Do not leave the DVD video camera/recorder on beach sand or in a closed vehicle where the  
temperature is very high for a long time: This could cause malfunctions.  
Do not point directly at the sun:  
If direct sunlight strikes the lens or viewfinder, the DVD video camera/recorder could malfunction  
or a fire could occur.  
Do not leave the DVD video camera/recorder with the LCD screen exposed to direct sunlight: This  
could cause malfunctions.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder near TV or radio:  
This could cause noise to appear on the TV screen or in radio broadcasts.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder near strong radio waves or magnetism:  
If the DVD video camera/recorder is used near strong radio waves or magnetism, such as near a  
radio wave tower or electric appliances, noise could enter video and audio that are being recorded.  
During playback of normally recorded video and audio, noise may also be present in picture and  
sound.  
At worst the DVD video camera/recorder could malfunction.  
Do not expose the DVD video camera/recorder to soot or steam:  
Thick soot or steam could damage the DVD video camera/recorder case or cause malfunctions.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder near corrosive gas:  
If the DVD video camera/recorder is used in a place where there is dense exhaust gas generated  
by gasoline or diesel engine, corrosive gas such as hydrogen sulfide, or sulfur such as in a hot  
spring area, the external or internal terminals could corrode, which would disable normal  
operation, or the battery connecting terminals could corrode, so power will not turn on.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder near ultrasonic humidifier:  
With some water in humidifier, calcium and other chemicals dissolved in water could scatter in the  
air, and white particles could adhere to the optical head of the DVD video camera/recorder, which  
could cause it to operate abnormally.  
Do not expose the DVD video camera/recorder to insecticide:  
Insecticide entering the DVD video camera/recorder could dirty the lens in laser pickup block,  
and in such a case the DVD video camera/recorder might not operate normally. Turn the DVD  
video camera/recorder off and cover it with vinyl sheet, etc. before using insecticide.  
Do not use a generally available 8 cm CD lens cleaner:  
Cleaning the lens is not necessary when using this DVD video camera/recorder in the usual way.  
Using 8 cm CD lens cleaner could cause this DVD video camera/recorder to be faulty.  
If you have to clean the lens, use a Hitachi Maxell cleaner that is exclusively for 8 cm DVD discs.  
6
Be careful of moisture condensation:  
When you move the DVD video camera/recorder between places where the difference in  
temperatures is great – such as entering a lodge from a ski slope or going out of a cooled room or  
vehicle – condensation (vapor in air warmed or cooled to water droplets) could occur on the lens  
and/or inside the DVD video camera/recorder. If condensation occurs, do not open the cover of  
disc or card insertion block if possible. If condensation occurs on the lens, wipe it off with a soft,  
dry cloth. Even if the external surface of DVD video camera/recorder has dried, condensation may  
remain inside: Turn the DVD video camera/recorder off and leave it in a dry place for at least 1 – 2  
hours before using it again.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder for a long uninterrupted period of time:  
This DVD video camera/recorder cannot be used for a long time continuously as a surveillance  
camera/monitor. If you use it for a long continuous period of time, the temperature of DVD video  
camera/recorder could exceed the limit and the recording/playback operation may slow down or  
other faults could occur. If this happens, turn it off and wait for a while before using it again.  
Do not turn the DVD video camera/recorder off while the ACCESS/PC indicator or  
CARD ACCESS indicator is lit or blinking:  
The ACCESS/PC or CARD ACCESS indicator is lit or  
blinking to show that data is being written to disc or card,  
or being read from it. At this time, do not do any of the  
following, so as not to damage the data:  
Remove battery  
Disconnect AC adapter/charger  
Plug or unplug PC connection cable  
Remove disc or card  
ACCESS/PC  
indicator  
Subject DVD video camera/recorder to severe  
vibrations or impact.  
Violently open or close the LCD monitor  
The ACCESS/PC indicator will light for a while after  
recording is finished. While it is lit, do not subject the DVD  
video camera/recorder to any vibration or impact, and do  
not disconnect the battery or AC adapter/charger.  
If you turn the DVD video camera/recorder off while the  
ACCESS/PC or CARD ACCESS indicator is lit or blinking,  
turn it on again with the disc or card loaded in it: Repair of  
the disc or card will be executed automatically (see page 171).  
CARD ACCESS indicator  
Do not wipe the DVD video camera/recorder case with benzene or thinner:  
The coating of case could peel off or the case surface could deteriorate.  
When using a chemical cleaning cloth, follow the instructions.  
Also read the instructions attached with optional accessories:  
For optional accessories, observe the cautions and follow instruction manuals attached.  
The battery provided has not been charged at time of purchase:  
Charge it before using the DVD video camera/recorder (see page 40).  
The battery will discharge as time passes. (The battery is produced so that it discharges on its own  
in order to protect its characteristics.)  
Disc cannot be inserted or removed unless a charged battery or AC adapter/  
charger is connected to the DVD video camera/recorder.  
Be sure to set the power switch to “OFF” when turning the DVD video camera/  
recorder off:  
Disconnecting the battery or AC adapter/charger while the DVD video camera/recorder is being  
powered could cause a fault.  
7
Cautions When Storing  
Do not leave the DVD video camera/recorder in a place where the temperature is  
very high for a long period of time:  
The temperature inside a closed vehicle or trunk can become very high in a hot season. If you leave  
the DVD video camera/recorder in such a place, it could malfunction or the case could be  
damaged. Also, do not expose the DVD video camera/recorder to direct sunlight or place it near a  
heater.  
Do not store the DVD video camera/recorder in a place where the humidity is high  
or in a dusty place:  
Dust entering the DVD video camera/recorder could cause malfunctions. If the humidity is high,  
the lens could be moldy, and the DVD video camera/recorder could become inoperable. It is  
recommended that you put the DVD video camera/recorder with desiccant in a box when storing  
it in a closet, etc.  
Do not store the DVD video camera/recorder in a place subject to strong  
magnetism or intense vibrations:  
This could cause malfunctions.  
Detach the battery from the DVD video camera/recorder and store it in a cool place:  
Leaving the battery attached or storing it at high temperature could shorten its life.  
Suggestions and Restrictions  
Make a trial recording:  
Always make a trial recording before doing actual recording to make sure that recording is normal.  
The data that have not been stored normally because of a defect in the DVD video camera/  
recorder cannot be restored.  
It is recommended that you use DVD-RAM disc from which recorded contents can be deleted for  
trial recording.  
Do not use the DVD video camera/recorder for professional applications:  
This DVD video camera/recorder is designed and produced for home-use recording and playback.  
The recorded contents cannot be compensated for:  
Hitachi cannot compensate for any damages caused when recording is not made normally or  
recorded contents cannot be played back because of a defect in the DVD video camera/recorder,  
disc or card. Also, Hitachi cannot be responsible for your recorded video and audio.  
If you or a third party make a mistake when handling this DVD video camera/recorder, disc, card,  
etc., the recorded contents may be lost. We cannot be responsible for compensation for damage due  
to loss of recorded contents.  
Copyright:  
Data recorded on the disc or card in this DVD video camera/recorder using other digital/analog  
media or devices are protected by the copyright act and cannot be used without permission of the  
owner of copyright, except for personal enjoyment. Be aware that recording is restricted for some  
demonstrations, performances and exhibitions, even for personal enjoyment.  
8
Read This First  
To guide you, we have included following six chapters.  
The section on “Setups” explains how to set  
up the DVD video camera/recorder, battery,  
and set the date/time.  
The section on “Basic Techniques” explains the  
basic operation of this DVD video camera/  
recorder – recording of movies, still images,  
external input, and playback of recorded  
images.  
We want this manual to be as helpful as  
possible, so it includes two easy ways to find the  
information you need:  
A quick index for the information you use  
most often (this page).  
A detailed table of contents directing you to  
specific information quickly (see pages 12 –  
14).  
The section on “Advanced Techniques”  
explains settings on this DVD video camera/  
recorder for more advanced usage.  
The section on “Disc Navigation” explains  
editing with Disc Navigation: Refer to this  
section when finalizing DVD-RW/DVD-R disc  
and initializing DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc.  
The section on “Connecting to PC” explains  
the contents of provided CD-ROM and how to  
install the software included.  
Get to know your DVD video camera/recorder by  
using this manual, and get to know Hitachi. We  
appreciate your business.  
Quick Index  
Available Discs ................................................ 25  
Recording Movie ............................................. 50  
Playing Back.................................................... 59  
Connecting to a TV.......................................... 80  
Functions Available with Disc Navigation ...... 110  
Connecting to PC .......................................... 141  
“Subsidiary Information” includes an  
introduction to products sold separately,  
proper cleaning, and troubleshooting.  
With this DVD video camera/recorder you can view the picture being recorded or the playback  
picture whether on the LCD monitor or in the viewfinder. Opening or closing the LCD monitor  
switches the picture to appear on the LCD monitor or in the viewfinder.  
It is possible to switch the language in the on-screen display of this DVD video camera/recorder  
(see page 104).  
About This Manual  
Displays in this manual  
Understand that the displays are different from those you will actually see in the viewfinder or on  
the LCD screen.  
Notation of cancel button  
Press the stop/cancel button to stop your operation midway, or return the menu screen to the  
preceding one. The expression “press the C button” will be used in this text.  
1, <, >, 2 and 3 marks beside headings  
Some functions of this DVD video camera/recorder are unavailable with disc or card used. Refer to  
the marks at right above each function to identify whether the disc or card is compatible with the  
function. Refer to these marks and identify the functions and operation to match the disc or card you  
use.  
Illustrations in this manual  
Although the external appearances of DZ-GX20MA, DZ-MV780MA, DZ-MV750MA and DZ-BX31A  
are different, the method of operating these models is identical.  
The illustrations of DZ-GX20MA are used for the explanation in this text.  
9
Introduction  
You can start recording immediately after stopping playback (p. 50, 59)  
Unlike tape devices, you do not need to search for the recording start position or locate the  
beginning of blank portion.  
You can stop playback and immediately start recording: New recording will not overwrite any  
previously recorded data.  
Recorded scenes  
If you stop playback midway and start recording, overwrite will not occur.  
You can immediately play back desired recorded scenes (p. 108)  
You do not need to rewind, unlike recorders using tape.  
You can select any scene you want and immediately play it back (using Disc Navigation function).  
Use Disc Navigation to create your original movie (p. 127)  
You can delete unnecessary scenes, move any scenes, etc., and create your original movie work (Play  
List).  
Before editing  
After editing  
10  
You can easily edit scenes, which  
is quite difficult with tape (p. 86)  
Create original DVDs on PC  
(p. 150)  
Using this DVD video camera/recorder, you can  
collect scenes of your child, for example, on play  
list of Disc Navigation function and create an  
original movie: Then simply play back the play  
list and dub it on VCR or DVD recorder.  
You can create an original DVD, using the  
provided software CD-ROM.  
The created DVD disc can be played back on  
DVD player/recorder, DVD-ROM drive, etc.  
Up to now, you had to  
repeatedly press  
buttons  
With a DVD, you can  
simply play it back on this  
DVD video camera/  
recorder: Press the record  
button on VCR or DVD  
recorder.  
Original DVD being  
created  
Playback of DVD  
11  
Table of Contents  
CHANGING DISPLAY FORMAT OF DATE  
AND TIME.........................................................39  
Setting Up the Battery......................................40  
Important Information.........................................2  
For Your Safety..................................................2  
Precautions........................................................2  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS...........4  
Cautions When Using........................................5  
Cautions When Storing...................................... 8  
Suggestions and Restrictions ............................8  
Read This First ..................................................9  
About This Manual.............................................9  
Introduction......................................................10  
Table of Contents ............................................12  
Checking Provided Accessories ......................15  
Names of Parts................................................16  
Try Recording and Playing Back using Disc  
CHARGING BATTERY........................................40  
ATTACHING BATTERY TO DVD VIDEO  
CAMERA/RECORDER.....................................41  
REMOVING BATTERY........................................41  
BATTERY REMAINING LEVEL INDICATOR......43  
EFFICIENT USE OF BATTERY ..........................43  
USING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER WITH  
AC ADAPTER/CHARGER................................44  
Turning DVD Video Camera/Recorder On  
and Off...........................................................45  
Inserting and Removing Disc...........................46  
INSERTING DISC................................................46  
REMOVING DISC................................................48  
Inserting and Removing Card..........................49  
(Video and Photo) .........................................20  
Try Recording and Playing Back using Card  
(Photo) ..........................................................22  
Discs and Cards .............................................. 24  
Basic Techniques  
Recording Movie..............................................50  
Recording Stills................................................52  
On-Screen Information ....................................53  
INFORMATION DISPLAY DURING  
RECORDING....................................................53  
Zooming...........................................................57  
AVAILABLE DISCS ............................................. 25  
INFORMATION ON DVD-R DISC....................... 25  
EXAMPLES OF DISCS THAT CANNOT BE  
USED ON THIS DVD VIDEO CAMERA/  
RECORDER: .................................................... 26  
HANDLING DISCS.............................................. 27  
DISC CLEANING................................................. 27  
AVAILABLE CARDS............................................ 28  
COMMON CAUTIONS FOR DISC AND CARD .......28  
MACRO RECORDING ........................................58  
RECORDING SUBJECTS FOR STRONGER  
WIDE-ANGLE OR TELEPHOTO EFFECT.......58  
Playing Back....................................................59  
Storage Capacity on Disc or Card ...................29  
PLAYING BACK ..................................................59  
PLAYBACK FROM START OF DISC OR  
CARD................................................................60  
SEARCH PLAYBACK OF MOVIE .......................60  
FRAME ADVANCE/FRAME BACK/SLOW  
RECORDABLE TIME OF MOVIE (VIDEO)......... 29  
RECORDABLE STILLS (PHOTOS) ON  
DVD-RAM......................................................... 29  
RECORDABLE STILLS (PHOTOS) ON  
PLAYBACK OF MOVIE ....................................60  
SKIP PLAYBACK OF MOVIE..............................61  
PLAYING BACK STILLS .....................................61  
JUMPING TO SPECIFIED POINT (GO TO)........62  
CARD................................................................ 30  
SIZE AND QUALITY OF PHOTOS ..................... 31  
Setups  
Setting Up the DVD Video Camera/  
Recorder .......................................................32  
On-Screen Information Display........................63  
INFORMATION DISPLAY DURING  
PLAYBACK.......................................................63  
HOLDING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/  
Checking Flow of Quick Menu.........................64  
Camera Functions  
RECORDER ..................................................... 32  
ATTACHING SHOULDER STRAP...................... 33  
ATTACHING LENS CAP..................................... 33  
INSERTING BATTERY INTO REMOTE  
CONTROL........................................................ 34  
REMOVING BATTERY FROM REMOTE  
CONTROL........................................................ 34  
VIEWING IMAGE ON LCD MONITOR  
SCREEN........................................................... 36  
CLOSING LCD MONITOR .................................. 37  
VIEWING SUBJECT THROUGH  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING  
MOVIE: .............................................................66  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING  
PHOTO (DISC):................................................67  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING  
PHOTO (CARD): ..............................................69  
Disc Navigation Functions  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU  
(WITH DVD-RAM DISC):..................................71  
VIEWFINDER ................................................... 37  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU  
(WITH DVD-RW DISC):....................................72  
SETTING DATE AND TIME ................................ 38  
12  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU  
(WITH DVD-R DISC): .......................................73  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU (WITH CARD):............74  
SETTING BRIGHTNESS OF VIEWFINDER  
(EVF BRIGHTNESS) ......................................101  
SETTING COLOR DENSITY  
(COLOR LEVEL).............................................102  
ALWAYS DISPLAYING IMAGE IN  
VIEWFINDER .................................................102  
Initial Settings................................................ 103  
Manually Focusing Subject ..............................75  
FOCUSING DURING RECORDING....................75  
Adjusting Brightness of Image to be recorded  
(Exposure).....................................................77  
Compensating for Backlight .............................77  
Using External Microphone..............................78  
Built-in Video Flash (for DZ-GX20MA only) .....79  
Viewing on TV Screen......................................80  
SWITCHING OPERATING SOUND ON OR  
OFF (BEEP)....................................................103  
TURNING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER  
OFF AUTOMATICALLY (POWER SAVE) ......103  
TURNING RECORD LED ON OR OFF  
(RECORD LED)..............................................104  
CONNECTING TO A TV......................................80  
VIEWING ON TV SCREEN .................................81  
Playback on DVD Recorder/Player..................82  
CHANGING DISPLAY LANGUAGE  
(LANGUAGE)..................................................104  
RESETTING MENU SETTINGS TO  
DEFAULTS (RESET)......................................105  
PLAYING BACK  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) DISC.............82  
PLAYING BACK  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R DISC...................82  
Disc Navigation  
Using Disc Navigation ................................... 106  
Recording (Dubbing) Images ...........................83  
STARTING OR TERMINATING DISC  
NAVIGATION..................................................106  
PLAYING BACK FROM DISC NAVIGATION  
SCREEN.........................................................108  
SELECTING MULTIPLE SCENES....................109  
SELECTING CONSECUTIVE SCENES  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES FROM  
OTHER VIDEO DEVICE...................................83  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES FROM  
OTHER VIDEO CAMERAS ..............................85  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES ON  
TOGETHER....................................................109  
OTHER VIDEO DEVICES ................................86  
FUNCTIONS AVAILABLE WITH DISC  
NAVIGATION..................................................110  
UNDERSTANDING FLOW OF DISC  
NAVIGATION MENU ......................................111  
Advanced Techniques  
Checking Flow of Normal Menu.......................87  
Camera Functions  
Scene ............................................................ 113  
Setting Up Camera Functions..........................89  
DELETING SCENES (EDIT – DELETE) ...........113  
DIVIDING MOVIES (EDIT – DIVIDE) ................115  
COMBINING MULTIPLE SCENES  
(EDIT – COMBINE).........................................116  
ARRANGING ORDER OF SCENES  
(EDIT – MOVE)...............................................116  
DIRECTING SCENES EFFECTIVELY  
(EFFECT – FADE)..........................................117  
SELECTING SHOOTING MODE TO MATCH  
THE SUBJECT  
(SWITCHING PROGRAM AE MODE)..............89  
RECORDING DARK SUBJECTS USING LCD  
MONITOR LIGHT .............................................90  
ADJUSTING COLOR (WHITE BALANCE)..........91  
USING THE ELECTRONIC IMAGE  
STABILIZER (EIS)............................................93  
RECORDING SUBJECT USING LARGE  
MAGNIFICATION (DIGITAL ZOOM)................93  
REDUCING WIND NOISE DURING  
PLAYING BACK BY SKIPPING SCENES  
(EFFECT – SKIP) ...........................................118  
CHANGING IMAGES FOR THUMBNAILS  
(EFFECT – THUMBNAIL)...............................119  
COPYING STILLS ON DVD-RAM DISC TO  
CARD (COPY) ................................................120  
LOCKING SCENES ON CARD (LOCK)............121  
SELECTING SCENES USING MENU SCREEN  
(SELECT)........................................................122  
DISPLAYING INFORMATION USING MENU  
SCREEN (DETAIL).........................................123  
RECORDING (MIC.FILTER) ............................93  
Setting Up Record Functions ...........................94  
SWITCHING MOVIE QUALITY  
(VIDEO MODE) ................................................94  
SETTING TO WIDE TV SCREEN MODE  
(16:9 MODE).....................................................95  
SWITCHING QUALITY OF STILL IMAGE  
(QUALITY)........................................................97  
RECEIVING IMAGE FROM ANOTHER DEVICE  
(INPUT SOURCE) ............................................97  
SWITCHING EXTERNAL INPUT RECORDING  
METHOD (PHOTO INPUT) ..............................98  
SELF-TIMER .......................................................99  
SETTING ON-SCREEN DISPLAY OUTPUT  
ON OR OFF (OSD OUTPUT).........................100  
Program......................................................... 124  
WHAT IS “PROGRAM”?....................................124  
SWITCHING TO THUMBNAIL DISPLAY OF  
SPECIFIC DATE (SWITCH) ...........................124  
PLAYING BACK PROGRAM (PLAY) ................125  
CHANGING TITLE OF PROGRAM (TITLE)......125  
Play List......................................................... 127  
LCD/EVF Setup..............................................101  
WHAT IS “PLAY LIST”?.....................................127  
CREATING NEW PLAY LIST (CREATE) ..........127  
SETTING BRIGHTNESS OF LCD SCREEN  
(LCD BRIGHTNESS)......................................101  
13  
TOC  
SWITCHING TO DISPLAY OF EACH PLAY LIST  
(SWITCH) ....................................................... 128  
PLAYING BACK A PLAY LIST (PLAY) ............. 128  
ADDING SCENES TO PLAY LIST  
Cautions When Using DVD Video Camera/  
Recorder by Connecting It to PC.................160  
Introduction to Video Editing Software...........161  
(EDITING PLAY LIST).................................... 129  
DELETING SCENES FROM PLAY LIST  
Subsidiary Information  
Introduction to Optional Accessories .............162  
(EDITING PLAY LIST).................................... 130  
ADDING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR  
EDITING (EDITING PLAY LIST) .................... 130  
DELETING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR  
EDITING (EDITING PLAY LIST) .................... 131  
SELECTING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR  
EDITING (EDITING PLAY LIST) .................... 131  
ARRANGING ORDER OF SCENES (MOVE)... 132  
CHANGING TITLE OF PLAY LIST (TITLE) ...... 133  
CAMERA ACCESSORIES ................................162  
POWER SUPPLY..............................................162  
Removing Disc from Its Package...................163  
REMOVING AND REPLACING FROM/IN ROUND  
DVD HOLDER ................................................163  
REMOVING DISC FROM CARTRIDGE............164  
Cleaning.........................................................164  
Changing Setting of Demonstration...............165  
Terminology...................................................166  
No DVD Video Camera/Recorder Operation –  
Check the Following:...................................169  
Trouble Messages .........................................171  
Troubleshooting.............................................178  
System Reset ................................................185  
Major Specifications.......................................186  
To Order in the United States........................189  
To Order in the Canada.................................189  
Index..............................................................190  
Be sure to read the following before opening  
the package of CD-ROM.............................192  
DELETING PLAY LIST (DELETE) .................... 133  
Go To.............................................................134  
TOP (END) ........................................................ 134  
Disc or Card Management.............................135  
INITIALIZING DISC OR CARD  
(FORMAT DISC. FORMAT CARD) ................ 135  
PROTECTING DISC FROM WRITING  
(PROTECT DISC)........................................... 136  
VERIFYING REMAINING FREE SPACE ON  
DISC OR CARD (CAPACITY) ........................ 136  
UPDATING CONTROL INFORMATION OF  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) DISC  
(UPDATE CONTROL INFO.).......................... 137  
FINALIZING DVD-RW/DVD-R DISC  
(FINALIZE DISC)............................................ 138  
Others............................................................139  
DISPLAYING MOVIES OR STILLS  
INDEPENDENTLY (CATEGORY).................. 139  
PLAYING BACK SCENES REPEATEDLY  
(REPEAT PLAY)............................................. 139  
SLIDE SHOW  
(CONTINUOUS PLAYBACK OF STILLS) ...... 140  
Connecting to PC  
THE FOLLOWING ARE AVAILABLE WHEN  
CONNECTING TO PC.................................... 141  
To Copy Still Data on PC...............................143  
Contents on Provided CD-ROM ....................143  
Installing Software .........................................145  
DISPLAYING INSTALLER SCREEN ................ 145  
INSTALLING SOFTWARE ................................ 146  
Creating DVD Video (DVD-RW/DVD-R) from  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) Disc  
Recorded on DVD Video Camera/  
Recorder .....................................................150  
INSERTING 3D TITLE IMAGES........................ 152  
CREATING A DVD VIDEO (DVD-RW/DVD-R)  
USING SCENES RECORDED ON MULTIPLE  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-MODE) DISCS....... 154  
CAPTURING SCENES ON DVD-RAM/DVD-RW  
(VR-MODE) INTO PC..................................... 156  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE HDD MODE..................... 158  
REUSING A RECORDED DVD-RW ................. 159  
Uninstalling Software.....................................160  
14  
Checking Provided Accessories  
Make sure that you have all the following accessories in package:  
Battery (model DZ-BP14S):  
For DZ-GX20MA only.  
Battery (model DZ-BP7S):  
For DZ-MV780MA, DZ-MV750MA, DZ-  
AC adapter/charger (model DZ-ACS2):  
Used to power the DVD video camera/  
Portable power supply for this DVD video  
camera/recorder. Charge it before use.  
BX31A only. Portable power supply for this recorder from AC outlet, or charge battery.  
DVD video camera/recorder. Charge it  
before use.  
DC power cord:  
Power cable:  
Infrared remote control  
When powering the DVD video camera/  
recorder from household AC outlet, use  
this cord to connect the DVD video  
camera/recorder and AC adapter/charger.  
Connect between household AC outlet and (model DZ-RM4W):  
AC adapter/charger.  
Use to control the DVD video camera/  
recorder from a distance. For DZ-GX20MA  
or DZ-MV780MA only.  
Lithium battery (model CR2032):  
To power the remote control. For DZ-  
GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only.  
AV/S input/output cable:  
Used when viewing the picture played back Attach to the DVD video camera/recorder  
on the DVD video camera/recorder on TV  
screen, or input or output video from/to  
another video device.  
Shoulder strap:  
to hang it from shoulder.  
WARNING: Keep  
this battery away  
from children. If  
swallowed, consult  
a physician  
immediately for  
emergency  
treatment.  
Lens cap and lens cap string:  
Attach the lens cap when not recording, to To record videos (movies) on this DVD  
protect the lens.  
Single-sided 8 cm DVD-R disc:  
Software CD-ROM:  
Use this CD-ROM when connecting the  
DVD video camera/recorder to PC. For DZ-  
GX20MA, DZ-MV780MA and DZ-  
MV750MA only.  
video camera/recorder. For DZ-GX20MA,  
DZ-MV780MA and DZ-MV750MA only.  
PC connection cable:  
Use this cable when connecting the DVD  
video camera/recorder to PC.  
Disc cleaning cloth:  
Always use this to clean discs.  
15  
Names of Parts  
7
8
9
10  
1
2
3
4
5
6
11  
12 13  
(Inside the cover)  
14  
Zoom lever (p. 57)  
1
Light receiving sensor  
(for DZ-GX20MA only)  
9
Push the lever to the T side for telephoto, or  
to the W side for wide-angle.  
This sensor controls the amount of light to be  
emitted from the built-in flash. Take care not  
to block with hand, etc. during recording.  
10 Accessory shoe (p. 79)  
For DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only:  
The optional video flash can be attached  
here. (See the instruction manual of device to  
be attached for details.)  
2
3
4
5
Flash (for DZ-GX20MA only) (p. 79)  
Lens cap string attachment hole (p. 33)  
Stereo microphone (p. 51)  
11 PC connection terminal (TO PC) (p. 141)  
12 AV input/output jack (p. 80, 83)  
Recording indicator (p. 104)  
The red indicator will light during recording.  
13 External microphone jack (p. 78)  
6
Infrared receiver (for DZ-GX20MA or  
DZ-MV780MA only) (p. 35)  
When the remote control is used to operate  
the DVD video camera/recorder, this  
receiver will receive the infrared signal.  
14 2.5" type liquid crystal display (inside)  
(p. 36)  
Although the external appearances of DZ-  
GX20MA, DZ-MV780MA, DZ-MV750MA  
and DZ-BX31A are different, the method of  
operating both models is identical. DZ-  
GX20MA illustrations are used in this  
manual.  
7
Optical 10× zoom lens  
(for DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only)  
Optical 16× zoom lens  
(for DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A only)  
(p. 57)  
8
Lens hood (p. 58)  
Always remove this lens hood when using  
generally available tele-conversion or wide-  
conversion lens.  
16  
15  
16  
17 18 19  
20  
OTO  
H
P
ACCESS/PC  
DISC EJECT  
21 22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
15 Viewfinder (p. 37)  
21 BATTERY EJECT button (p. 41)  
Press this button when removing the battery.  
16 Diopter control (p. 37)  
22 Battery attachment platform (p. 41)  
23 Record button (REC) (p. 50)  
To adjust the focus of image appearing in the  
viewfinder. (Pull out the viewfinder.)  
17 ACCESS/PC indicator (p. 7, 50, 52)  
24 LOCK switch (p. 51)  
Will blink or light when the disc in DVD  
video camera/recorder is accessed (write or  
read is executed) or the DVD video camera/  
recorder is connected to PC.  
It is recommended that you set the LOCK  
switch to L (to the upper position) to prevent  
the power switch in the “O” position from  
accidentally moving to “N”.  
18 PHOTO button (p. 52)  
25 Power switch (p. 45)  
26 Hand strap (p. 32)  
19 DISC EJECT button (p. 46)  
Press down and release this button to open  
the cover of disc insertion block.  
20 Disc insertion block (p. 46)  
17  
27  
28  
29  
30 31 32 33  
DISC  
NAVIGATION  
SELECT  
MENU  
STOP/EXIT  
QUICK  
MENU  
FOCUS  
EXPOSURE  
BLC  
VOL.  
DISPLAY  
34  
35  
36  
37 38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
27 QUICK MENU button (p. 64)  
36 DISPLAY (Screen display) button (p. 53, 63)  
Press this button to display the details of  
image being played back or camera setting  
status, or switch the display off.  
To display only the functions that you  
frequently use (simple menus).  
28 FOCUS button (p. 75)  
To switch between manual focus and auto-  
focus.  
37 CARD ACCESS indicator (p. 7, 52)  
38 Volume control buttons (VOL)/  
S R buttons (p. 59, 75, 77)  
To adjust the volume of sound from speaker,  
etc.  
29 MENU button (p. 38, 89, 114)  
Press this button to display the menu for  
setting camera functions and Disc  
Navigation.  
39 Card insertion block (p. 49)  
30 SELECT button (p. 109)  
40 BLC (backlight compensation) button  
(p. 77)  
31 DISC NAVIGATION button (p. 106)  
Press this button when subject is being  
lighted from rear.  
32 STOP/EXIT button (p. 9, 59, 65)  
To end playback or cancel setting of menu.  
41 f / e / d / c / A buttons  
(p. 38, 59, 65, 87)  
33 EXPOSURE button (p. 77)  
Press this button to adjust the exposure.  
Use these buttons to select a scene or menu  
item, and then press the center (A) to play  
back the scene, or designate an option from  
the menu.  
34 Speaker (p. 59)  
35 RESET button (p. 185)  
To reset all settings to defaults (status when  
the DVD video camera/recorder was  
shipped from the factory)  
42 Tripod threaded hole  
Used to attach the DVD video camera/  
recorder to a tripod.  
18  
43  
44  
REC  
PHOTO  
DISPLAY  
ZOOM  
50  
DIGITAL  
ZOOM  
MENU  
45  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
SELECT  
46  
47  
48  
49  
DELETE  
57  
58  
DISC  
NAVIGATION  
43 PHOTO button (p. 52)  
51 ZOOM T button (p. 57)  
44 REC button (p. 50)  
52 DIGITAL ZOOM button (p. 57)  
53 ZOOM W button (p. 57)  
45 MENU button (p. 38, 89, 114)  
46 SELECT button (p. 109)  
47 Reverse search button (p. 60)  
48 DELETE button (p. 113)  
49 DISC NAVIGATION button (p. 106)  
50 DISPLAY button (p. 53, 63)  
54 Reverse skip button (p. 61)  
55 Forward search button (p. 60)  
56 Play/pause button (p. 59)  
57 Stop button (p. 9, 59, 65)  
58 Forward skip button (p. 61)  
* The buttons on remote control will function the same as those on DVD video camera/recorder.  
19  
1<>2  
Try Recording and Playing Back using Disc  
(Video and Photo)  
It is recommended that you use a DVD-RAM disc for trial recording,  
Before You Begin  
since you can delete the recorded contents (p. 24).  
You can record both videos and photos on a DVD-RAM (generally available), but only videos on a  
DVD-RW/DVD-R (generally available).  
1
Connect a power supply (p. 44).  
Power cable  
1
2
4
AC adapter/charger  
3
DC power cord  
2
Insert a disc (p. 46).  
1 Press down the DISC EJECT button once  
3 Push the disc against the turntable at the  
center of disc insertion block to lock it  
until a click is heard, and then close the  
cover of disc insertion block: Do not touch  
the disc recording surface or pickup lens  
at this time.  
and release it.  
Disc cover  
DISC EJECT  
2 Gently open the cover until it stops.  
Turntable  
20  
3
Start recording (p. 50).  
1 Open the LCD monitor (p. 36), or pull out  
the viewfinder (p. 37).  
3 When recording a video, press the REC  
button.  
2 While holding down the button on the  
right of power switch, set the switch to  
O” or “N” (only “O” for DVD-RW/  
DVD-R disc).  
Recording will start.  
Pressing the REC button again will stop  
recording (O).  
When recording a photo, press the  
PHOTO button.  
Pressing PHOTO half way (half press)  
allows you to focus the subject, and the  
m” indicator will turn purple. Press  
PHOTO all the way down to record.  
Note:  
When using an unformatted disc, format (initialize) it on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
If unformatted disc is inserted into this DVD video camera/recorder, a message will appear: Format the disc  
following the instructions on screen (p. 24, 47, 135). Initializing the DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc will erase all the  
recorded contents: Make sure the contents on disc are not valuable before initializing the disc.  
See Check 1 on p. 169 if recording is not possible with “O”.  
See Check 2 on p. 169 if recording is not possible with “N”.  
4
View the playback of recorded content on LCD monitor screen (p. 36).  
1 After recording is finished, press the A  
button.  
The recorded scene will be played back.  
2 Press the C button to stop playback.  
2
1
STOP/EXIT  
21  
3
Try Recording and Playing Back using Card  
(Photo)  
Only photos can be recorded on a card (generally available).  
1
Connect a power supply (p. 44).  
Power cable  
1
2
4
AC adapter/charger  
3
DC power cord  
2
Insert a card (p. 49).  
1 Open the LCD monitor (p. 36).  
3 Put in a card.  
2 Open the cover of card insertion block  
4 Insert the card all the way until it locks,  
and then close the cover of card insertion  
block.  
with power turned off.  
22  
3
Start recording (p. 52).  
1 Open the LCD monitor (p. 36).  
3 Press the PHOTO button half way (half  
press): When a subject image is focused,  
the “m” indicator will turn purple.  
2 While holding down the button on the  
right of power switch, set the switch to  
P”.  
4 Press the PHOTO button all the way (full  
press).  
Note:  
With the DZ-GX20MA only, the built-in flash may emit light in a dark area (see page 79).  
See page 24 for the cards that can be used on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
See Check 2 on p. 169 if recording is not possible with “P”.  
4
View the playback of recorded content on LCD monitor screen (p. 36).  
1 Press the A button in recording pause  
status: The recorded scene will be played  
back.  
2 Press the C button to stop playback.  
2
1
STOP/EXIT  
23  
Discs and Cards  
The following table lists the storage media (discs and cards) that can be used on this DVD video  
camera/recorder and the functions which are available with them:  
Media  
DVD-RW  
DVD-RW  
SD memory  
card  
Function  
DVD-RAM  
DVD-R  
(VR mode) (VF mode)  
To record video (p. 50)  
To record photo (p. 52)  
To delete image (p. 113)  
To edit image (p. 115 – 116)  
To play on other DVD device  
(p. 138)  
*1  
*1*2  
*2  
*2  
*3  
To use new disc or new card  
without formatting  
*4  
*4  
To initialize and reuse  
*7  
*5  
*5  
To capture image in PC  
*7  
*5  
To edit on PC  
To create DVD video using  
*6  
*6  
*7  
PC  
*8  
To copy still data on PC  
: Functions available; —: Not available  
*1: Playable on devices that conform to either 8 cm DVD-RAM or 8 cm DVD-RW (VR mode).  
*2: Must be finalized (see “Terminology”, p. 166). Cannot be played on some DVD players or DVD recorders.  
*3: Some DVD devices conform to SD memory card.  
*4: When media that are sold “formatted” are used. If the initialization format differs, the media can be initialized on  
this DVD video camera/recorder and then used.  
*5: The provided software (DVD-MovieAlbumSE) is used.  
*6: The provided software (DVDfunSTUDIO) is used.  
*7: No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
*8: If you use Windows XP, photos can be imported from DZ-BX31A.  
24  
AVAILABLE DISCS  
Available Discs  
This DVD video camera/recorder can use only  
the 8-cm bare discs not packed in a square  
cartridge, square caddy case or round DVD  
holder. The discs in a square cartridge, square  
caddy case or round DVD holder can be used if  
they are removed from the package, but take  
great care not to dirty or scratch the bare disc  
(see pages 163 and 164).  
Usable discs and logos  
DVD-RAM Ver. 2.1 (8 cm)  
Note:  
It is recommended that you use Hitachi Maxell HG  
type single-sided discs, since their compatibility with  
this DVD video camera/recorder has been confirmed.  
When using an HG type double-sided disc, take great  
care with handling it. Using a disc other than these  
discs may not allow the DVD video camera/recorder  
to deliver optimum performance.  
DVD-RW  
[for General Ver1.1 (8 cm) 2x speed  
(2x/1x)]  
DVD-R  
[for General Ver. 2.0 (8 cm)]  
See below for information on DVD-R disc.  
INFORMATION ON DVD-R DISC  
You cannot record a still on DVD-R disc, or delete any recorded images or data.  
For optimum recording on DVD-R disc, this DVD video camera/recorder writes control data to the  
disc in order to automatically make adjustments when it is inserted and ejected accompanying  
recording. If the disc has no area to be written for adjustment, recording may not be possible. To  
prevent this, do not insert or eject a DVD-R disc accompanying recording more than 100 times.  
Although some models are compatible with the VR mode using DVD-R disc, this DVD video  
camera/recorder is not compatible with that mode.  
8 cm DVD-R disc provided  
Before using the 8 cm DVD-R disc provided on this DVD video camera/recorder on a DVD player or  
DVD video recorder that is compatible with 8 cm DVD-R disc, the disc must be finalized on this  
DVD video camera/recorder. For the finalizing procedure of 8 cm DVD-R disc, refer to  
“FINALIZING DVD-RW/DVD-R DISC (FINALIZE DISC)” (p. 138).  
Note:  
When using an unformatted DVD-R or DVD-RW disc, it is necessary to format it on this DVD video camera/  
recorder (see page 47).  
Do not insert a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder but not finalized,  
into a recordable device, such as a DVD recorder: The recorded data may be damaged (except for devices that  
allow playback of a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc not finalized on this DVD video camera/recorder).  
Use only DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A/DZ-GX20A/DZ-MV780A/DZ-MV730A to record  
on or finalize a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder but not finalized:  
Using any other device could damage the data recorded on the disc.  
DVD-R or DVD-RW discs edited and finalized on PC or those finalized on another DVD recorder may not be  
playable on this DVD video camera/recorder, depending on the editing software used or recorded status of DVD-R  
disc.  
If you insert a DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder or a DVD video camera/recorder other  
than DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A/DZ-GX20A/DZ-MV780A/DZ-MV730A and not  
finalized, the Disc Navigation screen will automatically start, and no recording can be done on the disc nor can it  
be finalized.  
Do not insert a DVD-R that was recorded by a DVD recorder manufactured by a company other than Hitachi, and  
which has not been finalized, in this DVD video camera/recorder: Doing so will make the disc unusable.  
25  
EXAMPLES OF DISCS THAT CANNOT BE USED ON THIS DVD VIDEO  
CAMERA/RECORDER:  
CD  
CD-R  
CD-RW  
CD-ROM  
DVD-R (double-layered)  
DVD-R (4.7 GB) for Authoring Ver. 2.0  
DVD+R  
DVD-ROM  
DVD-Video  
+RW  
Discs other than those with diameter of 8 cm  
Note:  
Discs recorded on PC or DVD recorder may not be  
playable on this DVD video camera/recorder: If so,  
message “This disc cannot be used.will appear. Also,  
blue thumbnails will appear (Fig. 1* on page 27), or  
normal playback will not be possible.  
26  
HANDLING DISCS  
When recording images,  
the DVD video camera/  
recorder may avoid the  
portions of disc where  
recording is not possible,  
due to dust, scratches,  
etc. [It will pause m at  
such a portion and  
Using discs  
Discs are very delicate recording media.  
Carefully read the following cautions and  
observe them:  
Always use a brand new disc when recording  
important material.  
Be sure not to touch the recording surface of  
disc, or dirty or scratch it.  
If there is dust, scratch, dirt on disc or if it is  
warped, the following phenomena may occur:  
Block noise in playback  
image  
Momentary stop of  
playback image  
Sound interrupted during  
playback, or abnormal  
sound  
Blue thumbnail  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
001 / 002  
PLAY  
RAM  
(Recording one scene  
may produce multiple  
thumbnails.)  
automatically restart  
recording (n).]  
This will cause recording to be interrupted for  
several seconds to several minutes, and  
multiple thumbnails will be created by one  
recording session as shown above. In this case,  
the recordable time on disc will decrease.  
Be careful when removing the disc since the  
metal of removal slot of DVD video camera/  
recorder, and disc itself, may be hot.  
Block noise  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
001/ 006  
display* (Fig. 1)  
Disc cannot correctly  
be recognized  
Disc cannot be  
initialized  
Delay between video  
and audio  
Even if disc is normal, the above phenomena  
may occasionally occur. While the ACCESS/  
PC indicator is lit, do not subject disc to  
vibrations or impact, and avoid using DVD  
video camera/recorder at extremely high or  
low temperatures, or in environment where  
condensation is likely to occur.  
Storing discs  
When storing disc, replace it in the plastic case  
in which it was purchased.  
Be careful that no condensation occurs on disc.  
Do not place disc in following places:  
Direct sunlight for a long time  
Where humidity is high or in dusty place  
Where there is heat from a heater, etc.  
PLAY  
RAM  
Fig. 1  
*
DISC CLEANING  
Use the disc cleaning cloth provided to lightly  
wipe off any dirt adhering to the disc as shown  
in the figure. Do not wipe the disc with force:  
Doing so could cause scratches.  
Never use solvent (thinner, water, antistat or  
detergent) for cleaning.  
Use the disc cleaning  
cloth to clean from inner  
to outer edges in axial  
direction.  
Lightly wash the dirty cleaning cloth with  
detergent: The dirt removal capacity of the cloth  
will improve (rinse the cloth well with water so  
that no detergent remains).  
27  
AVAILABLE CARDS  
COMMON CAUTIONS FOR DISC AND  
CARD  
It is recommended that you create a backup  
file for valuable data on hard disk of PC.  
Do not do the following, or the data on disc or  
card may be damaged or lost:  
SD memory card can be used on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
When using an exclusive adapter, a miniSD  
memory card can be used in the same way as an  
SD memory card.  
Do not remove the disc or card or turn DVD  
video camera/recorder off during reading or  
writing of data  
Do not use DVD video camera/recorder in a  
place subject to static electricity or electrical  
noise  
Do not have printing done at a print lab or  
DPE service.  
Handling card  
Do not use cards other than  
the designated ones.  
Note:  
This DVD video camera/recorder can play back image  
data recorded on other digital cameras conforming to  
the DCF (Design rule for Camera File system)  
standard. The range of image data playable on this  
DVD video camera/recorder is that with pixels from 80  
horizontal × 60 vertical to 4000 horizontal × 3000  
vertical.  
DCF is an integrated image file format of digital  
cameras: Image files can be used on all digital  
devices conforming to DCF.  
Image data edited on PC and certain types of image  
data may not be visible on this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
The image data recorded on another device may not  
be playable on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Be sure to use a brand new  
card when recording vital  
images.  
Do not touch the card  
terminal or allow it to touch  
Terminal  
metal.  
Do not paste anything other  
than exclusive label on label pasting portion.  
Do not subject card to impact, bend or drop it.  
Do not disassemble card or modify it.  
Do not expose card to water.  
Do not use or store card in the following  
places:  
Where the temperature is high, such as in  
vehicle at high temperatures, under burning  
sun or near a heater.  
Where humidity is high, or in dusty place  
When the erasure prevention switch is locked,  
no recording, deletion or editing will be  
possible on the card: Only playback will be  
possible.  
Note when transferring or  
discarding discs and memory  
cards:  
“Formatting” or “deletion” using the functions  
of DVD video camera/recorder or PC will  
change only the file control information: It will  
not completely delete the data on disc or  
memory card.  
When transferring or discarding a disc or  
memory card, it is recommended that you  
physically destroy it or use deletion exclusive  
software (generally available) to completely  
delete the data on it. It is user’s responsibility to  
control the data on disc and memory card.  
Erasure prevention  
switch  
Locked status  
28  
Storage Capacity on Disc or Card  
RECORDABLE TIME OF MOVIE (VIDEO)  
The recordable time will vary depending on the video recording quality: See page 94 for the setting  
of video recording quality.  
Movie recordable time on one disc (on single side) (when recording only movies)  
Recording quality  
XTRA  
Movie recordable time  
Application  
*1  
Approx. 18 min  
Best quality  
High quality  
*2  
FINE  
STD  
Approx. 30 min  
Approx. 60 min  
*3  
Standard quality  
*1: Variable bit recording (recording of more than 18 minutes may be possible because the transfer rate varies  
automatically between approx. 3 – 10 Mbps)  
*2: Fixed bit rate: Approx. 6 Mbps  
*3: Fixed bit rate: Approx. 3 Mbps  
Note:  
No movie can be recorded on SD memory card.  
Although the movie quality mode or wide-screen (16:9) mode can be changed midway for recording on DVD-  
RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc, it cannot be changed on DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc once the mode has  
been selected.  
If you record in XTRA mode at high temperatures, the DVD video camera/recorder will heat up and the maximum  
transfer rate will be limited to approx. 6 Mbps, so the best quality will not be obtainable.  
If a disc recorded is used at high temperatures, normal playback may be impossible: Turn the DVD video camera/  
recorder off once, wait until the ambient temperature becomes lower, and then operate it again.  
RECORDABLE STILLS (PHOTOS) ON DVD-RAM  
Number of recordable stills on one side of disc  
DZ-GX20MA:  
Can record up to approx. 750 photos (up to 999 photos with external input).  
DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A:  
Can record up to approx. 999 photos (up to 999 photos with external input).  
If the disc still has free space after recording the above maximum number of photos on it, movies can  
also be recorded on it.  
29  
RECORDABLE STILLS (PHOTOS) ON CARD  
The number of recordable stills will vary depending on the recording quality: See page 97 for the  
setting of recording quality.  
For DZ-GX20MA  
Capacity  
Recording  
quality  
16 MB  
32 MB  
64 MB  
128MB  
Approx. 120  
Approx. 160  
Approx. 240  
256 MB  
Approx. 240  
Approx. 320  
Approx. 480  
512 MB  
Approx. 480  
Approx. 640  
Approx. 960  
1 GB  
FINE  
NORM  
ECO  
Approx. 13 Approx. 29 Approx. 60  
Approx. 18 Approx. 38 Approx. 80  
Approx. 27 Approx. 58 Approx. 120  
Approx. 900  
Approx. 1,200  
Approx. 1,800  
For DZ-MV780MA  
Capacity  
Recording  
quality  
16 MB  
32 MB  
64 MB  
128MB  
Approx. 240  
Approx. 320  
Approx. 480  
256 MB  
Approx. 480  
Approx. 640  
Approx. 960  
512 MB  
Approx. 960  
Approx. 1,280  
Approx. 1,920  
1 GB  
FINE  
NORM  
ECO  
Approx. 27 Approx. 58 Approx. 120  
Approx. 36 Approx. 76 Approx. 160  
Approx. 54 Approx. 116 Approx. 240  
Approx. 1,800  
Approx. 2,400  
Approx. 3,600  
For DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
Capacity  
Recording  
quality  
16 MB  
32 MB  
64 MB  
128MB  
256 MB  
512 MB  
1 GB  
FINE  
NORM  
ECO  
Approx. 108 Approx. 232 Approx. 480  
Approx. 216 Approx. 464 Approx. 960  
Approx. 960  
Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840  
Approx. 7,500  
Approx. 15,000  
Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840 Approx. 7,680  
Approx. 432 Approx. 928 Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840 Approx. 7,680 Approx. 15,360 Approx. 30,000  
With external input  
Capacity  
128MB  
Approx. 960  
Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840 Approx. 7,680  
Recording  
quality  
16 MB  
32 MB  
64 MB  
256 MB  
512 MB  
1 GB  
FINE  
NORM  
ECO  
Approx. 108 Approx. 232 Approx. 480  
Approx. 216 Approx. 464 Approx. 960  
Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840  
Approx. 7,500  
Approx. 15,000  
Approx. 432 Approx. 928 Approx. 1,920 Approx. 3,840 Approx. 7,680 Approx. 15,360 Approx. 30,000  
(The numbers of recordable stills above are only for reference)  
Note:  
Cards used on other devices can be used on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
No movie or music data recorded on card can be checked, viewed or heard on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
In addition, no such a data file can be displayed on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Use the remaining display function to check the remaining free space on disc before use. See “VERIFYING  
REMAINING FREE SPACE ON DISC OR CARD (CAPACITY)” on page 136.  
Some still data recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder may not be playable on another device.  
30  
SIZE AND QUALITY OF PHOTOS  
The pixel size of stills (JPEG) that can be recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder is as follows:  
Setting  
Model  
Camera input  
1,600 × 1,200 pixels  
External input  
640 × 480 pixels  
DZ-GX20MA  
DZ-MV780MA  
1,280 × 960 pixels  
640 × 480 pixels  
640 × 480 pixels  
640 × 480 pixels  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
The following table shows the file size and quality of one still (JPEG) recorded on card:  
File size  
Quality  
Application  
DZ-MV750MA/  
DZ-BX31A  
DZ-GX20MA  
DZ-MV780MA  
External input  
FINE  
Approx. 1,024 KB Approx. 512 KB  
Approx. 128 KB  
Approx. 128 KB  
When image quality is  
prioritized  
NORM Approx. 768 KB  
ECO Approx. 512 KB  
Approx. 384 KB  
Approx. 256 KB  
Approx. 64 KB  
Approx. 32 KB  
Approx. 64 KB  
Approx. 32 KB  
Standard quality  
When number of stills is  
prioritized (quality will be  
slightly inferior)  
Although still images are recorded on DVD-RAM disc only in the FINE mode, the quality mode can  
be chosen when recording stills on card (p. 97).  
The file size of a photo recorded on DVD-RAM disc in “N” status is equal to or larger than that  
recorded on card using the FINE quality in “P”.  
* JPEG: Joint Photographic Experts Group.  
JPEG is one of the photo image compression standards. It is widely used in digital still cameras since  
JPEG files can be used on ordinary PC. When this DVD video camera/recorder records on DVD-  
RAM disc in “N” status, a JPEG photo will be recorded, along with a photo that conforms to the  
DVD video recording (DVD-VR) format which is used to be output to TV (see “Terminology”,  
p. 166). Only JPEG photos will be recorded on SD memory card.  
Note:  
No still can be recorded on DVD-RW/DVD-R disc.  
Since the file size is restricted in all quality modes when recording photos on card (P), the quality of photos on  
card may be inferior to those recorded on DVD-RAM disc (N).  
31  
Setups  
This section explains preparations for recording – setting up the DVD video camera/recorder  
and battery.  
Setting Up the DVD Video Camera/Recorder  
HOLDING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER  
Insert your right hand from the bottom of DVD video camera/recorder up to the base of your  
thumb.  
Put your hand in a position where you can easily operate the REC button and the Zoom lever.  
Adjust the length of hand strap so that the DVD video camera/recorder is stable when you press the  
REC button with your thumb.  
Note:  
Caution:  
Do not adjust the hand strap while holding the DVD  
Do not lift the DVD video camera/recorder by  
video camera/recorder: Doing this could cause the DVD  
holding the viewfinder or LCD monitor: If the  
video camera/recorder to fall and be damaged.  
viewfinder or LCD monitor comes off, the DVD video  
camera/recorder will fall.  
32  
ATTACHING SHOULDER STRAP  
Be sure to pass through the 2 slots.  
Pass the shoulder strap through  
the shoulder strap attachments.  
ATTACHING LENS CAP  
1
2
Attach the shorter end of lens cap string to  
the lens cap.  
Shorter end  
Attach the longer end of lens cap string to the  
attachment hole of DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
Longer end  
3
Push the both sides of cap inward and attach  
it over the lens.  
Push and fit  
Note:  
Always keep the lens cap on when not using the DVD  
video camera/recorder, to protect the lens.  
When recording, attach the lens cap to the hand strap  
by hooking the tab inside the cap onto strap for  
comfortable shooting.  
33  
INSERTING BATTERY INTO REMOTE CONTROL  
Insert the provided lithium battery into remote control.  
1
2
While inserting a fine rod into the hole  
marked PUSH, pull the battery holder out  
forward.  
3
Slide the cover to close it.  
Note:  
The life of lithium battery is approximately one year. If  
the battery is discharged, no operation is possible with  
remote control: Replace the battery.  
Insert the lithium battery with the positive R  
terminal facing down.  
Battery holder  
REMOVING BATTERY FROM REMOTE CONTROL  
1
While pushing the battery holder, slide the  
battery out.  
Warning:  
Note:  
KEEP THE BATTERY AWAY FROM CHILDREN AND  
PETS.  
Replace the battery with a Hitachi Maxell, Sony,  
Panasonic, Sanyo, Toshiba CR2032, or Duracell  
DL2032. Use of another battery may present a risk of  
fire or explosion.  
IF SWALLOWED, CONSULT A PHYSICIAN  
IMMEDIATELY FOR EMERGENCY TREATMENT.  
BATTERY MAY EXPLODE IF NOT HANDLED  
PROPERLY. DO NOT RECHARGE, DISASSEMBLE  
OR DISPOSE OF IN FIRE.  
Dispose of battery safely in accordance with local  
laws. Do not dispose of in fire.  
Do not short circuit the battery.  
Do not hold the battery with the metallic tweezers.  
Keep the battery in a dark, cool, dry place.  
The remote control (DZ-RM4W) and lithium battery  
(CR2032) are supplied only with the DZ-GX20MA and  
DZ-MV780MA.  
34  
Using Remote Control  
Point the remote control to the infrared receiver on the DVD video camera/recorder. The remote  
controllable distance is up to 16 feet (5 m).  
10º  
10º  
15º  
15º  
Infrared receiver  
Note:  
When using the remote control, make sure that the  
infrared receiver on DVD video camera/recorder is not  
exposed to direct sunlight or any intense light. If the  
infrared receiver is subject to light stronger than the  
infrared light from remote control, the DVD video  
camera/recorder cannot be operated by remote  
control.  
The DVD video camera/recorder uses the “VCR2”  
remote control code of Hitachi VCRs. If you use a  
Hitachi VCR, etc. with remote control code set to  
“VCR2”, a VCR placed near the DVD video camera/  
recorder will also be operated by the remote control:  
To prevent this, change the remote control code of the  
VCR.  
If there is an obstacle between the remote control and  
infrared receiver on DVD video camera/recorder,  
remote control may not be possible.  
The remote control (DZ-RM4W) and lithium battery  
(CR2032) are supplied only with the DZ-GX20MA and  
DZ-MV780MA.  
35  
VIEWING IMAGE ON LCD MONITOR SCREEN  
If you open the LCD monitor, you can monitor subject image on the LCD screen.  
1
Open the LCD monitor.  
The LCD monitor has a portion where you  
can hook your finger. Hook the finger there to  
open the monitor.  
Range where the LCD monitor can  
be moved  
90º  
The LCD monitor can be opened up to  
approximately 90º.  
If the LCD monitor is open 90º, it can be tilted  
with the screen down as much as 90º, and can  
also be tilted with screen up and turned up to  
180° so the screen faces in the same direction as  
the lens.  
Hook your finger  
(Bottom)  
If the LCD monitor is turned 180º so the screen  
faces in the same direction as the lens during  
recording, subject image will also appear in the  
viewfinder as a mirror image (left/right  
reversed).  
90º  
Tilt the LCD monitor to adjust its vertical angle  
so that you can see the screen easily.  
180º  
Note:  
If no image appears on LCD monitor screen, refer to  
“Check 7” on page 170.  
If LCD monitor lights white, refer to page 90.  
Be sure to open the LCD monitor approximately 90º  
before changing its vertical angle.  
Do not record for a prolonged time with the LCD  
monitor turned approximately 180º in close contact  
with the DVD video camera/recorder body: Doing this  
could cause the DVD video camera/recorder and LCD  
monitor to become hot.  
36  
CLOSING LCD MONITOR  
Before closing the LCD monitor, be sure to reset  
it at right angles to the DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
Note:  
Be sure to return the LCD monitor at right angles to  
the DVD video camera/recorder before closing it or  
replacing it on the DVD video camera/recorder with its  
screen facing outside. If the LCD monitor is tilted, it  
cannot be closed to the DVD video camera/recorder.  
If the LCD monitor is not securely locked to the DVD  
video camera/recorder, no image will appear in the  
viewfinder.  
Replace the LCD monitor on the DVD video  
camera/recorder with the LCD screen facing  
inward until a click is heard.  
VIEWING SUBJECT THROUGH VIEWFINDER  
1
2
Pull out the viewfinder.  
Diopter control  
Viewfinder  
Turn the diopter control knob to adjust the  
focus to suit your eyesight.  
Note:  
If no image appears in viewfinder, refer to “Check 6”  
on page 170.  
If the LCD monitor is opened approximately 90º, the  
viewfinder will be off: Turn the open LCD monitor 180º  
so that it faces the same direction as the lens; the  
image will appear in the viewfinder.  
Focusing will not be correct unless the viewfinder is  
pulled out.  
Pull out the viewfinder  
until a click is heard.  
See “LCD/EVF Setup” (on page 101) if you wish to  
display images in the viewfinder regardless of  
whether you open or close the LCD monitor.  
37  
SETTING DATE AND TIME  
Set the current date and time so that the date and time you make a recording can be recorded  
correctly.  
The following procedure can also be used to correct the date and time you have already set.  
MENU  
Use f / e / d / c buttons  
to select, and then press A to  
designate.  
1
2
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder on.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
Press the d or c  
button to select the digit  
you want to set in  
sequence.  
Da t e Se u p  
t
Da t e Se  
Da t e Mode  
t
9
/ 30  
8
/
:
2006  
00AM  
Ca  
m
e r a F u nc  
P r og r a  
h i t e Ba l .  
t
i
on s Se t u p  
m
AE  
:
:
:
:
:
A u t o  
A u t o  
On  
W
The menu screen will  
appear.  
E
I
S
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
D i g .  
M
Z
o om  
t e r  
4 0 x  
O
Press the f or e  
IC . F  
i
l
f
f
button to select the  
number for current date/time, and then  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RA  
M
repeat step 5 to set the current date and time.  
3
4
Use the f/e/d/  
c buttons to choose  
“Date Setup” and then  
“Date Set”.  
Note:  
Da t e Se  
t
u p  
To stop date/time setting midway, press the C  
button.  
Da t e Se  
Da t e Mode  
t
1
/
1
12  
/
:
2006  
00AM  
6
7
After setting the current  
date and time, press the  
A button.  
Da t e Se  
t
ENTER  
RETURN  
u p  
RAM  
9 / 30 / 2006 8 : 00A  
M
Da t e se t up?  
YES  
Press the c button.  
Da t e Se  
t
NO  
The screen for verifying  
the set date will appear.  
ENTER  
RAM  
The figure for the  
month will be selected.  
[The digit that is  
highlighted first  
depends on the date  
Da t e Se  
Da t e Mode  
t
1
/
1
12  
/
:
2006  
00A  
M
If the displayed date and time are correct, use  
press the d button to choose “YES”, and  
then press the A button.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
display format (set up in Date Mode): The  
digit on the left end of the date display will  
be first highlighted.]  
The date and time will be set, and the DVD  
video camera/recorder will enter the  
recording pause status.  
Note:  
After setting the figure for the month, press the c  
button to select the digit to be set. If you press the  
A button after selecting the figure for the month,  
the screen for verifying the set date will appear  
instead of screen for setting day, year or time.  
Choosing “NO” will restore the menu screen.  
Note:  
This DVD video camera/recorder incorporates a  
rechargeable battery to store the date and time in  
memory. If this built-in battery is exhausted, the date  
and time will be reset. To prevent this, connect the AC  
adapter/charger to DVD video camera/recorder every 3  
months, and leave them for at least 24 hours with the  
DVD video camera/recorder turned off: The built-in  
battery will be charged.  
38  
CHANGING DISPLAY FORMAT OF DATE AND TIME  
You can select one of three date display formats: month/day/year, day/month/year or year/  
month/day. Associated with the selected date display, the time display format will also change as  
follows:  
Date display format  
Example of display  
5:00PM  
9/30/2006  
M/D/Y  
17:00  
30/ 9/2006  
D/M/Y  
Y/M/D  
PM 5:00  
2006/ 9/30  
1
2
Press the MENU button.  
3
4
Use the f/e/d/  
Da t e Se u p  
t
c buttons to select the  
desired date display  
format, and then press  
the A button.  
The menu screen will appear.  
D a t e S e t  
D a t e M o d e  
D/M/  
Y
Use the f/e/d/  
Da t e Se u p  
t
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
c buttons to choose  
“Date Mode” on the  
“Date Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
The menu screen for  
setting date will be restored, and the “Date  
Mode” has been changed as you designated.  
D a t e S e t  
D a t e M o d e  
M/D/  
D/M/  
Y / M/ D  
Y
Y
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Press the MENU button to switch off the  
menu screen.  
The options will appear on the right of “Date  
Mode”: The Z mark will be attached to the  
currently selected option.  
Note:  
If the date display format has been changed, the display  
format during playback as well as during recording will  
also be changed (see page 53).  
39  
Setting Up the Battery  
The DZ-BP14S battery provided with DZ-GX20MA or DZ-BP7S battery provided with DZ-MV780MA,  
DZ-MV750MA and DZ-BX31A has not been charged at purchase time: Charge it before using the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
Note:  
Be sure to use the DZ-BP14S, DZ-BP7S, DZ-BP14SW (optional) or DZ-BP7SW (optional, unavailable for DZ-  
GX20MA) battery for the DVD video camera/recorder: Using other batteries could cause the DVD video camera/  
recorder to malfunction, or result in fire.  
Be sure to use the DZ-ACS2 AC adapter/charger to charge the battery: Using other chargers could cause electric  
shock or fire.  
Charge the battery at temperatures of 50 – 86ºF (10 – 30ºC).  
If the CHARGE indicator does not light when the AC adapter/charger is plugged into AC outlet, unplug it from the  
AC outlet, wait a few moments, and then plug it into the AC outlet again. If the CHARGE indicator still does not  
light, the AC adapter/charger may be faulty. Unplug it from the AC outlet and consult your dealer.  
The AC adapter/charger can be used around the world. An AC plug adapter is required in some foreign countries.  
If you need one, purchase it from your local electronics distributor.  
AC 200 – 240V  
AC Plug Adapter (not supplied)  
CHARGING BATTERY  
Use the provided AC adapter/charger to charge the battery.  
1
2
Connect the power cable to AC adapter/  
charger.  
3
Attach the battery to AC adapter/charger.  
Note:  
When charging a battery, unplug the DC power cord  
from the DC output jack on AC adapter/charger.  
Plug the power cable into AC outlet.  
Battery  
Power cable  
CHARGE indicator  
AC adapter/charger  
DC output terminal  
40  
Battery charged status  
You can find out the charged status of battery by checking the CHARGE indicator on AC adapter/  
charger:  
Charge status  
During charge  
CHARGE indicator  
Lit  
Charge complete  
Goes out  
Note:  
See “Troubleshooting” on page 178 when the CHARGE indicator blinks.  
Reference for time required to charge battery (at approx. 77ºF (25ºC)):  
DZ-BP14S (provided with DZ-GX20MA)/DZ-BP14SW (optional): Approx. 165 minutes  
DZ-BP7S (provided with DZ-MV780MA, DZ-MV750MA and DZ-BX31A)/DZ-BP7SW (optional,  
unavailable for DZ-GX20MA): Approx. 90 minutes  
The charge time will vary depending on the remaining power level of battery.  
ATTACHING BATTERY TO DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER  
1
Fit the battery to the battery attachment  
platform on this DVD video camera/recorder  
and slide it downward until a click is heard.  
Note:  
Make sure that the battery is in the correct orientation.  
Make sure that the battery is securely attached:  
Incomplete attachment could cause the battery to fall,  
resulting in damage.  
Terminal  
side must be  
down.  
REMOVING BATTERY  
After using the DVD video camera/recorder, remove the battery from it.  
1
While holding down the BATTERY EJECT  
button, slide the battery upward to remove it.  
Note:  
For safety, be sure to turn the DVD video camera/  
recorder off before attaching or removing the battery.  
Be careful not to drop the removed battery.  
If the battery remains attached, minute level current  
will flow even if the DVD video camera/recorder is off,  
and the battery will discharge.  
41  
Continuously recordable time with fully charged battery (with no zoom  
operation, etc.)  
See the following table as a reference for how long the DVD video camera/recorder can  
continuously be used with a fully charged battery:  
With DZ-BP14S (provided with DZ-GX20MA)/DZ-BP14SW (optional)  
DZ-MV750MA/  
DZ-BX31A  
Video mode  
DZ-GX20MA  
DZ-MV780MA  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
approx. 125 min  
approx. 110 min  
approx. 125 min  
approx. 110 min  
approx. 140 min  
approx. 125 min  
approx. 145 min  
approx. 125 min  
approx. 145 min  
approx. 125 min  
approx. 170 min  
approx. 145 min  
approx. 170 min  
approx. 145 min  
approx. 170 min  
approx. 145 min  
approx. 210 min  
approx. 170 min  
*
XTRA  
FINE  
STD  
With DZ-BP7S (provided with DZ-MV780MA, DZ-MV750MA and DZ-BX31A)/DZ-BP7SW**  
(optional)  
DZ-MV750MA/  
DZ-BX31A  
Video mode  
DZ-MV780MA  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
When using viewfinder  
When using LCD monitor  
approx. 70 min  
approx. 60 min  
approx. 70 min  
approx. 60 min  
approx. 80 min  
approx. 70 min  
approx. 85 min  
approx. 70 min  
approx. 85 min  
approx. 70 min  
approx. 100 min  
approx. 85 min  
*
XTRA  
FINE  
STD  
* The time is only for reference: It will vary depending on recording contents.  
**Unavailable for DZ-GX20MA.  
The reference for how long the DVD video camera/recorder can actually be used  
will be approx. 1/2 to 1/3 of the above time:  
The continuously recordable time of DVD video camera/recorder in the above table shows the time  
available when the DVD video camera/recorder is in the recording mode without using any other  
function after recording is started. In actual recording, the battery will discharge 2 – 3 times faster  
than this reference, since the REC button and zoom are being operated, and playback is performed.  
Assume that the actually recordable time with a fully charged battery is between 1/2 and 1/3 of the  
above time, and prepare enough batteries to allow for the time you are planning to record on the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
The continuously recordable time may be less depending on the conditions when the DVD video  
camera/recorder is used (if recording and recording pause are repeated at short intervals, etc.).  
Note that the battery discharges faster in cold places.  
Note:  
See “Troubleshooting” on page 178 when charging is not possible.  
The charge time will vary depending on the battery remaining level.  
During and after charging, and when the DVD video camera/recorder is being used, the battery will be warm, but  
this does not indicate a fault.  
A battery cannot be charged while the DC power cord is connected to the DC output jack of AC adapter/charger:  
Unplug the DC power cord when charging a battery.  
Charge the battery at ambient temperature 50ºF to 86ºF (10ºC to 30ºC): Charging at temperatures other than this  
range could damage the battery.  
42  
BATTERY REMAINING LEVEL INDICATOR  
When the battery is used to power the DVD video camera/recorder, the battery remaining level  
appears in the viewfinder or on the LCD screen as follows:  
Fully charged  
Nearly empty  
White portion shows remaining level  
(Blinks)  
EFFICIENT USE OF BATTERY  
Charge battery immediately before using  
DVD video camera/recorder:  
Battery life:  
The battery life varies greatly depending on the  
ambient environment and how often the DVD  
video camera/recorder is used. If the usable  
time of DVD video camera/recorder with a fully  
charged battery is noticeably short, the battery is  
probably dead: Purchase a new one.  
The battery will slightly discharge even if it is  
detached from the DVD video camera/recorder.  
If the battery is left attached to DVD video  
camera/recorder, it will consume a slight  
amount of power.  
Therefore, it is recommended that you charge  
the battery shortly before using the DVD video  
camera/recorder, usually on the day before you  
plan to use it.  
However, since the battery used for this DVD  
video camera/recorder is free from the memory  
effect, you do not need to completely discharge  
the battery before charging it.  
Power save and discharge of battery:  
It is recommended that you turn the DVD video  
camera/recorder off in status other than  
recording, since even during recording pause  
battery power is consumed at the same level as  
during recording.  
If, when you specify Power Save On, the  
recording pause status continues for  
approximately 5 minutes, the DVD video  
camera/recorder will automatically turn off.  
To set or release power save, see “TURNING  
DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER OFF  
AUTOMATICALLY (POWER SAVE)” on  
page 103.  
When not using the DVD video camera/  
recorder for an extended period:  
It is recommended that you fully charge the  
battery once a year, attach it to DVD video  
camera/recorder and use it up; then remove the  
battery and store it in a cool place again.  
Store in cool, dark place:  
When you are not using the DVD video camera/  
recorder, remove the battery and store it in a  
cool, dark place. If you store it in a place where  
the temperature is high, the battery life will be  
shortened. Be especially sure not to store the  
battery in an environment (in a closed vehicle)  
over 140ºF (60ºC): Neglecting this could damage  
the battery. Also, do not store the battery in a  
place which is too cold, such as in a refrigerator:  
Doing so could cause condensation when using  
the DVD video camera/recorder with the  
battery.  
43  
USING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER WITH AC ADAPTER/CHARGER  
It is recommended that you use the AC adapter/charger to power the DVD video camera/recorder  
from household AC outlet when you perform settings on it, play back or edit images, or use it  
indoors.  
Note:  
Be sure to use the specified AC adapter/charger (DZ-ACS2) to power the DVD video camera/recorder. Using other  
AC adapter/chargers could cause electric shock or result in fire.  
Power cable  
1
2
4
AC adapter/charger  
3
DC power cord  
1
Connect the power cable to AC adapter/  
charger.  
2
3
Plug the power cable into AC outlet.  
Plug one end of DC power cord into the DC  
output jack on AC adapter/charger.  
4
Attach the other end of DC power cord to the  
battery attachment platform on DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
Use the same procedure as that for battery  
when attaching and detaching the DC power  
cord: See page 41.  
44  
Turning DVD Video Camera/Recorder On and  
Off  
While holding down the gray button at the right  
of power switch, set the switch according to  
each recording function:  
Note:  
Once you turn the DVD video camera/recorder on to  
let it recognize the disc, you can immediately record  
or play back by turning the DVD video camera/  
recorder on again. However, if a long time has  
elapsed after the disc was inserted, it will take some  
time for the DVD video camera/recorder to start  
because it must recognize the disc again (see  
page 169).  
Set to “OFF”:  
The DVD video camera/  
recorder will turn off  
Set to “P”:  
To record still on SD  
memory card  
It will take some time for the DVD video camera/  
recorder to display the Disc Navigation screen after  
power is turned on.  
If you turn the DVD video camera/recorder on, the  
ACCESS indicator will light or blink to show that the  
DVD video camera/recorder is recognizing the disc or  
card: During this time, no operation, such as  
recording, can be performed.  
After several seconds, the ACCESS indicator will go  
out, and operating the DVD video camera/recorder  
will be possible.  
If the ACCESS indicator does not go out, refer to  
“Check 4” on page 169.  
Set to “O”:  
To record movie on DVD-  
RAM/DVD-RW/DVD-R  
disc  
Set to “N”:  
To record still on DVD-  
RAM disc  
Power ON status  
During playback, set the power switch to “O”  
or “N” when using disc, or set it to “P” when  
using card.  
Turn the switch while holding down the gray  
button at the right of switch.  
ACCESS/PC  
indicator  
CARD ACCESS indicator  
When the DVD video camera/recorder is turned on,  
the self-diagnosis function will work and a message  
may appear. In this case, refer to “Trouble Messages”  
on page 171 and take corrective action.  
While the ACCESS/PC or CARD ACCESS indicator is  
lit or blinking, do not violently open or close the LCD  
monitor.  
Power switch  
When the ACCESS/PC or CARD ACCESS indicator  
is lit or blinking, do not remove the battery or AC  
adapter/charger.  
45  
Inserting and Removing Disc  
INSERTING DISC  
1
Press down the DISC EJECT button once and  
release it.  
4
Push the section marked “PUSH CLOSE” on  
the cover of disc insertion block, to close the  
cover.  
A few moments after the ACCESS/PC  
indicator blinks, the cover of disc insertion  
block will open.  
Then the DVD video camera/recorder will  
automatically recognize the disc: While the  
ACCESS/PC indicator is lit, do not cut off the  
power supply, and do not subject the DVD  
video camera/recorder to any vibrations or  
impact.  
2
3
Gently open the cover by hand fully until it  
stops.  
Push the disc against the turntable at the  
center to lock it until a click is heard.  
Identifying recording sides of  
disc:  
Single sided disc:  
“SIDE A” mark  
The recording side is  
opposite to the printed label.  
Double-sided disc:  
The recording side of “SIDE  
A” is opposite to the “SIDE  
A” marked side.  
The recording side of “SIDE  
B” is the “SIDE A” marked  
side.  
The opposite side is  
the “SIDE A”  
recording side.  
Turntable  
Push the shaded  
portion.  
Note that the recording surface of disc must face  
the inside of DVD video camera/recorder.  
Never touch the disc recording surface or pickup  
lens.  
Pickup lens  
Use the disc cleaning cloth provided to wipe off  
any dirt adhering to the disc recording surface.  
Do not use a dirtied or scratched disc.  
The recording side must face the inside (DVD  
video camera/recorder).  
46  
Note:  
If the cover of disc insertion block is open, the ACCESS/PC indicator will blink when an image is displayed on the LCD  
monitor screen: In this case, the DVD video camera/recorder will not turn off even if the power switch is set to “OFF”.  
If the cover remains open after a while, the DVD video camera/recorder will automatically turn off.  
Disc cannot be inserted or removed unless a charged battery or AC adapter/charger is connected to the DVD  
video camera/recorder.  
If a discharged battery is used, the disc cannot be inserted or removed: Connect a charged battery or AC  
adapter/charger to the DVD video camera/recorder.  
If there is some delay before recording starts, refer to “Check 4” on page 169.  
If the disc is not correctly attached to the turntable, it will be difficult to close the cover: If this happens, do not  
forcibly close the cover (this could cause a fault), but re-attach the disc to the turntable correctly.  
If a single-sided disc is inserted into DVD video camera/recorder with the printed label facing the inside, an error  
message will appear. Remove the disc and reinsert it with its recording side facing the inside. See “Trouble  
Messages” on page 171.  
• When using double-sided disc  
Recording is possible on both sides of double-sided disc. However, when recording or playback on one side is  
finished, recording or playback will not move automatically to the other side. Remove the disc once from the DVD  
video camera/recorder, turn over the disc and insert it again for continued use.  
The recording surfaces of double-sided disc are likely to become dirtied or scratched: Always make sure that  
there is no dirt or scratch on the recording surface facing the pickup lens, and then use the disc taking great care  
that it is not dirtied or scratched. Use the provided disc cleaning cloth to wipe off any dirt on disc (see page 27).  
When using brand-new DVD-RW/DVD-R disc  
Recognition of the disc  
will start.  
The messages on the right  
will appear in sequence by  
pressing the A button  
between messages.  
3
Confirm the message, and then press the A  
button.  
F o rma t D i s c  
D i s c i s n o t f o r m a t t e d .  
I f i t f o r m a t s , i t b e c o m e s  
p o s s i b l e t o u s e f o r c a m e r a .  
Note:  
Once a disc is formatted, no data can be recorded on  
that disc from a PC (see Note on this page).  
See page 94 for video mode.  
See page 95 for 16:9 mode.  
NEXT  
CANCEL  
When recording on this DVD video  
camera/recorder:  
When recording data from PC:  
While the above messages are being displayed,  
press the C button, or when message “Format  
the disc now?” appears, choose “NO” and then  
press the A button.  
However, if data from PC has not yet been  
recorded, the disc can be made usable on this  
DVD video camera/recorder. When inserting  
the disc into this DVD video camera/recorder,  
the same message will appear: If you wish to use  
it on this DVD video camera/recorder, choose  
“YES”.  
1
Confirm the following  
message on screen, and  
then press the A  
button.  
F o rma t D i s c  
Howeve r , when you r e c o r d  
f r om PC connec t i on  
t e r m i n a l ,  
p l e a s e d o n o t f ormat.  
NEXT  
CANCEL  
2
When using DVD-RW, choose the recording  
format (VR or VF mode), and then press the  
A button.  
When using DVD-R, choose “YES” and then  
press the A button.  
Note:  
Do not initialize a disc on which you wish to record  
data created using the application (DVDfunSTUDIO)  
of PC.  
When recording on DVD-RW that has been initialized  
from application (DVDfunSTUDIO) of PC, perform  
deletion using the application (DVDfunSTUDIO). (See  
“REUSING A RECORDED DVD-RW” on page 159.)  
F o r  
m
a t D i s c  
F o r  
m
a t D i s c  
A
l
l
d a t a  
w
i
l
l
b e d e l e t e d .  
Se l ec  
VR o de  
ENTER  
t
r
ec o r d  
f
o r  
m
a t .  
F o r m a t t h e d i s c n o w ?  
M
VF  
M
o de  
YES  
NO  
ENTER  
(When using DVD-RW)  
(When using DVD-R)  
The disc will be formatted.  
When formatting is finished, message “DVD-  
RW(VF)/R disc, Video mode and 16:9 mode  
cannot be changed” will appear.  
47  
REMOVING DISC  
1
Press down the DISC  
EJECT button once and  
release it.  
Note:  
Do not remove the battery or disconnect the AC  
adapter/charger during removal of the disc or until  
power is completely turned off: If you do, the disc  
cover will not open. If this happens, reattach the  
battery or AC adapter/charger, push down the DISC  
EJECT button once, and then release it.  
Do not insert anything other than the 8 cm DVD-RAM,  
DVD-RW or DVD-R disc into the disc insertion block:  
Doing so could cause malfunctions.  
In a moment, the cover  
of disc insertion block  
will open.  
DISC EJECT  
If the DVD video  
camera/recorder is on  
at this time, the  
“EJECT” indicator will blink on the LCD  
monitor or in the viewfinder.  
When inserting or removing the disc, BE SURE NOT  
to look into the lens in laser pickup: Doing so could  
damage your eyesight.  
2
3
Gently open the cover  
fully until it stops.  
Remove the disc.  
While pushing down the center portion of  
turntable, pick up the disc, holding its edge,  
to remove it.  
Turntable  
4
Gently push the section  
indicated “PUSH CLOSE”  
on the cover of disc  
insertion block, to close the  
cover.  
48  
Inserting and Removing Card  
1
2
3
Open the LCD monitor.  
Removing Card:  
Push the center of  
card edge.  
The card will come  
out so that it can  
be held by fingers.  
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder off.  
Open the cover of  
card insertion  
block.  
4
Inserting Card:  
Insert card with its  
terminal inward  
until it locks.  
5
Close the cover of  
card insertion  
block.  
Note:  
No card is provided with this DVD video camera/  
recorder: Buy cards if you need them.  
See page 30 for the capacity of cards and the number  
of recordable photos on them.  
49  
Basic Techniques  
This section explains about recording of movies and still images, and also basic settings on  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
1<>2  
Recording Movie  
Insert a recordable DVD-RAM/DVD-RW/DVD-R disc into this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
Before You Begin  
4
Press the REC button.  
Pressing REC  
once will start  
recording;  
pressing it once  
again will  
temporarily stop  
recording.  
ACCESS/PC  
indicator  
The “m” mark in the  
viewfinder or on the LCD  
screen will change to the  
n” mark, and recording  
will start.  
During recording, the  
recording indicator on the  
front of DVD video camera/  
recorder will light.  
Pressing REC again during  
recording will set the DVD  
video camera/recorder to  
the recording pause status.  
Recording  
indicator  
1
2
Remove the lens cap, and then point the DVD  
video camera/recorder at subject.  
5
When recording is finished, turn the DVD  
video camera/recorder off.  
Turn the DVD camera/recorder on.  
Set the power switch to “O” to turn the DVD  
video camera/recorder on.  
After the ACCESS/PC indicator goes out,  
perform the subsequent operation:  
3
Check the subject on the screen (viewfinder  
or LCD).  
When using the viewfinder, close the LCD  
monitor before pulling out the viewfinder.  
50  
Note:  
See “Check 1” on page 169 when recording movie is  
not possible.  
See “Check 4” on page 169 if it takes some time  
before recording is possible.  
See “Check 5” on page 170 if the DVD video camera/  
recorder does not operate.  
See page 53 for on-screen information display.  
It is recommended that you use DVD-RAM disc from  
which recorded contents can be deleted.  
Sound is recorded from the stereo microphone on the  
front of DVD video camera/recorder: Take care that  
this microphone is not blocked.  
After a pause during recording, no further recording  
will be possible while “DISC ACCESS” is being  
displayed.  
Recording will restart after the message disappears.  
Do not remove the battery or AC adapter/charger  
during recording: Doing so will usually result in  
incomplete recording, which could damage the data  
(see pages 7 and 171).  
Do not remove the battery or AC adapter/charger  
after pausing during recording, while message “DISC  
ACCESS” is being displayed, or while the ACCESS/  
PC indicator is lit or blinking (see pages 7 and 171).  
The minimum recordable time of movie is  
approximately 3 seconds.  
See page 104 for setting of Record LED (recording  
indicator) On/Off.  
For various functions available during recording, see  
“Setting Up Camera Functions” on page 89.  
Hitachi cannot be responsible for video and audio that  
cannot be recorded or edited because of any defect.  
The power switch can be changed over even during  
recording, but the operation will not be changed.  
It is recommended that you set the LOCK switch to L  
(the upper position) to prevent the power switch in the  
O” position from accidentally moving to “N” position.  
Each time the DVD video camera/recorder enters the  
recording pause status, the counter display will be  
reset to “0:00:00”.  
Do not insert a non-finalized DVD-RW (VF-mode)/  
DVD-R disc into another DVD device: Doing so could  
cause the disc to become unusable (except in the  
case of the devices that have a function that can play  
back a disc that has not been finalized on this DVD  
video camera/recorder).  
Do not insert a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R recorded  
on a DVD recorder manufactured by a company other  
than Hitachi, and not finalized, in this DVD video  
camera/recorder: Doing so will make the disc  
unusable.  
When using an unformatted DVD-RW/DVD-R disc, it  
is necessary to format it on this DVD video camera/  
recorder (see page 47).  
51  
13  
Recording Stills  
5
Press the PHOTO button all the way (full  
pressing).  
Note:  
Recording of still images is possible on DVD-RAM disc  
and card.  
The screen will be black, and then the  
ACCESS/PC  
indicator  
recorded still will be displayed. When the  
m” mark appears, you can proceed with  
the next recording; while “DISC ACCESS” or  
“CARD ACCESS” is being displayed, you  
cannot proceed with the next recording.  
PHOTO button  
Note:  
If you wish to record without locating a subject at the  
center of screen, first locate the subject at the center  
of screen, press the PHOTO button halfway down,  
determine the composition to be recorded, and then  
press the PHOTO button all the way down.  
If you press the PHOTO button all the way down at  
one stroke without pressing it half way, recording will  
be possible, but the focus may be incorrect.  
See “SIZE AND QUALITY OF PHOTOS” on page 31  
for details of photos on card.  
See “Check 2” on page 169 if recording photos is not  
possible.  
CARD ACCESS indicator  
Shake of the DVD video camera/recorder may cause  
blur in recorded image.  
1
2
Remove the lens cap, and then point the DVD  
video camera/recorder at subject.  
When holding the DVD video camera/recorder for  
recording, grasp it securely with both hands.  
When recording with higher zoom magnification, it is  
recommended that you secure the DVD video  
camera/recorder on a tripod.  
Do not remove the battery, AC adapter/charger or the  
card while the ACCESS/PC indicator is lit or blinking:  
Doing so may damage the card or the data on card.  
The range of screen in which recording is possible will  
be different for movie and still.  
Turn the DVD camera/recorder on.  
When using DVD-RAM disc:  
Set the power switch to “N”.  
When using card:  
Set the power switch to “P”.  
If focusing is difficult with auto focus, choose manual  
focus, and manually correct the focus before  
recording (see page 75).  
After the ACCESS indicator goes out,  
perform the subsequent operation:  
There may be a difference between the image you  
see on the LCD screen or viewfinder and the  
recorded image.  
3
4
Check the subject on the screen (viewfinder  
or LCD).  
When using the viewfinder, pull it out and  
close the LCD monitor.  
Press the PHOTO button half way (half  
pressing).  
The DVD video camera/recorder will  
automatically focus on the subject at the  
center of screen, and the “m” indicator on  
screen will light in purple (the focus will not  
change when manual focus is chosen).  
52  
1<>23  
On-Screen Information  
Various types of information will appear in the viewfinder or on the LCD screen during recording.  
DISPLAY  
INFORMATION DISPLAY DURING RECORDING  
See the next page for details.  
e
j
n
o
m
2. Program AE  
3. White balance  
4. EIS  
5. Manual Focus  
6. Backlight compensation  
p
l
7. Microphone filter  
8. 16:9 mode  
9. Video flash  
10. Self-timer  
11. External Input  
12. Recording status  
1. Recording mode  
Movie recording time  
REC  
0 : 0 0 : 0 0  
REM  
L IN  
j
13. Zoom  
1 0  
3 0 MIN  
17. Remaining space  
on disc/card  
14. Exposure correction  
18. Remaining  
battery level  
DISC ACCESS  
Warning message  
19. Volume  
8 : 0 0 A  
M
15. Disc/Card type  
Current date/time  
FINE  
9 / 3 0 / 2 0 0 6  
16. Movie recording quality  
The above screen is an example for explanation:  
It is different from the actual display.  
53  
1. Recording mode (p. 50, 52, 98)  
8. 16:9 mode (only in movie recording mode)  
(p. 95)  
: Movie  
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
No display : 16:9 mode OFF  
: Still (Disc)  
l
: 16:9 mode ON  
: External input still (field) (Disc)  
: External input still (frame) (Disc)  
: Still (Card)  
*2  
9. Video flash [when Video Flash (sold  
separately) is attached] (only in still recording  
mode) (p. 79)  
: External input still (field) (Card)  
: External input still (frame) (Card)  
No display : Emits light automatically  
: Always emits light  
2. Program AE (only in movie recording mode)  
(
)
(p. 89)  
: No light emission  
No display : Auto  
10.Self-timer (only in still recording mode) (p. 99)  
: Sports  
b
c
d
e
f
: Portrait  
No display : Self-timer OFF  
: Spotlight  
: Sand & Snow  
: Low Light  
: Self-timer ON  
q
(countdown is from 10 seconds)  
11.External Input (p. 98)  
3. White balance (p. 91)  
L IN  
S IN  
: AV input  
: S-VIDEO input  
*2  
No display : Auto  
: Set  
h
i
12.Recording status  
: Outdoor  
: Indoor1  
: Indoor2  
j
k
: During recording  
n
m
: During recording pause (lights in  
green)  
1
4. Electronic image stabilizer (EIS)* (p. 93)  
When focus locks during photo  
recording (lights in purple)  
No display : EIS OFF  
*3  
No display  
: EIS ON  
n
13.Zoom (p. 57)  
5. Manual focus (p. 75)  
W
No display : Autofocus  
(Digital Zoom: Off)  
X
: (display in English or German):  
o
r
v
Manual focus  
4
(Digital Zoom: 40×* )  
Y
: (display in French or Italian):  
Manual focus  
5
(Digital Zoom: 240×* only in movie  
recording mode)  
: (display in Spanish): Manual  
focus  
6. Backlight compensation (p. 77)  
14.Exposure correction  
No display : Auto  
No display : Backlight compensation OFF  
: Manual  
: Backlight compensation ON  
m
7. Microphone filter (only in movie recording  
mode) (p. 93)  
No display : Microphone filter OFF  
: Microphone filter ON  
p
54  
*7  
15.Disc/Card type  
17.Remaining space on disc/card  
: DVD-RAM  
REM XX  
MIN  
REM XX  
: Remaining recordable minutes  
during movie recording  
: Number of remaining recordable  
still images during still recording  
I
*8  
: DVD-RW (VR-mode/VF-mode)  
: DVD-R  
< / >  
K
*9  
: DVD-RAM (write-protected)  
: Protected DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
J
$
18.Remaining battery level (p. 43)  
: DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc finalized  
on this video camera/recorder  
: DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc finalized  
on a device other than this DVD  
video camera/recorder  
"
(full charge)  
w
x
y
z
?
(low remaining charge)  
: Finalized DVD-RW (VF-mode) disc  
#
!
19.Volume (p. 59)  
: DVD-R disc already finalized on this  
DVD video camera/recorder  
: DVD-R disc finalized on a device  
other than this DVD video camera/  
recorder  
:
N*  
The volume can be adjusted during  
external input and playback.  
*1 EIS cannot be used when recording photos on DZ-  
GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA.  
* Includes DVD-R recorded on a Hitachi  
DVD video camera/recorder model  
older than DZ-GX20MA/MV780MA/  
MV750MA/BX31A/GX20A/  
*2 Not displayed on DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A.  
*3 When no disc or card is in the DVD video camera/  
recorder, or disc has not yet been initialized, a write-  
protected disc or locked card, or a disc or card with  
no remaining space, has been inserted.  
*4 “60×” will appear on DZ-BX31A.  
*5 “1,000×” will appear on DZ-BX31A.  
MV780A/MV730A and not finalized.  
: SD memory card  
O
P
: Locked SD memory card  
*6  
No display  
*6 When a disc or card that cannot be used in this  
DVD video camera/recorder is inserted.  
16. Movie recording quality (when using disc) (p. 94)  
*7 No remaining time or number will be displayed with  
a protected disc or locked card, or finalized DVD-  
RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc.  
*8 In XTRA mode, possible recording time may be  
longer than the displayed time.  
XTRA  
FINE  
STD  
: Best quality  
: High quality  
: Standard quality  
Still recording quality (when using card) (p. 97)  
*9 The displayed number of recordable stills is for  
reference: This number may not decrease,  
depending on the recording conditions (not  
displayed with a DVD-RW/DVD-R disc).  
FINE  
NORM  
ECO  
: High quality  
: Standard quality  
: Number of recordable stills is  
prioritized  
Switching the information display mode  
You can switch the display mode of on-screen information:  
Press the DISPLAY button.  
The full and minimum display modes will alternate.  
Full display mode: All types of information will  
appear.  
DISPLAY  
Minimum display mode: The recording mode (see  
1 on page 53) and recording status (see 12 on  
page 53) will appear. If the DVD video camera/recorder has warning information, a warning  
message will appear.  
Note:  
The DVD video camera/recorder does not record the date and time as a part of image. However, this information  
during recording will be recorded with image as data which can be checked on Disc Navigation screen during  
playback (see “INFORMATION DISPLAY DURING PLAYBACK” on page 63).  
55  
Display when recording an image of yourself  
When recording with the LCD screen facing the same direction as the  
lens, the operating status will appear: The battery remaining level will  
appear only when the remaining level is very low, and the display will  
blink.  
The following operating status indicator will light or blink to give  
warning message to user. The message can be checked when returning  
the LCD monitor 180º to the original status from the status in which the  
LCD screen was facing the same direction as the lens.  
No warning/message (see page 53) will appear when recording with the LCD screen facing the same  
direction as the lens.  
Instead, the following screen display symbols will blink to inform you of the operation status of  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
When the LCD monitor is turned 180º from the position with the LCD screen facing the same  
direction as the lens, the warning/message can be checked.  
Interpreting symbols on LCD screen when recording with the screen  
facing the same direction as the lens:  
Operating status/  
warning message  
Screen  
display  
symbol  
Description  
A write-protected disc is loaded.  
X
A locked card is loaded.  
An unusable card is loaded.  
R
An attempt to record a still is being made with a DVD-RW/DVD-R  
N
disc used.  
An unusable disc is loaded.  
Battery remaining  
level  
During recording (lights in red).  
k
The remaining capacity on disc is approaching the limit 0 (blinks  
in red).  
During recording pause (lights in green).  
During focus lock (lights in purple).  
The remaining capacity on disc or card is approaching the limit 0  
(blinks in red).  
l
There is no remaining capacity on disc or card (blinks in green).  
An attempt to record a copy-guarded image is being made  
(blinks in green).  
Note:  
If the LCD screen is set facing the same direction as the lens, the LCD screen will display a mirror image (left and  
right reversed).  
If the LCD screen is set facing the same direction as the lens, you can also view subject image in the viewfinder.  
Although you can switch to the manual focus, exposure and on-screen display modes even during recording with  
LCD screen facing the same direction as lens, they will not appear on the screen.  
When the LCD monitor is opened and turned 180º with the Program AE set to Low Light, the monitor screen will  
light white (see page 90).  
56  
1<>23  
Zooming  
If you continue to hold the zoom lever on the  
“T” control side with Dig. Zoom specified, the  
digital zoom will be activated midway (when  
optical 10-power is exceeded on DZ-GX20MA or  
DZ-MV780MA, or optical 16-power is exceeded  
on DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A).  
You can zoom up to 240-power on DZ-GX20MA,  
DZ-MV780MA or DZ-MV750MA; up to 1,000-  
power on DZ-BX31A.  
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
Moving the zoom lever will display the  
digital zoom bar.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
W: recording wide area  
(wide-angle)  
When Dig. Zoom is “Off”  
W
T
When Dig. Zoom is “On” (40x*1)  
W
T
Digital zoom range  
When Dig. Zoom is “On” (240x*2)  
(only in movie recording)  
W
T
T: recording enlarged  
image (telephoto)  
Digital zoom range  
1
2
Press the MENU  
Note:  
Ca  
m
e r a F u nc  
t
i
on s Se t u p  
AE  
h i t e Ba l .  
The digital zoom setting will be stored in memory  
even if the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
You can also use the DIGITAL ZOOM button on  
remote control to switch the digital zoom setting:  
Pressing the button during movie recording will switch  
button, choose “Dig.  
Zoom” on the “Camera  
Functions Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
P r og r a  
m
W
E
D i  
I
S
g
.
Z
F
o om  
t e r  
2 4 0 x  
4 0 x  
M IC .  
i
l
Of  
f
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
the setting between “Off”, “40×”*1, and “240×”*2  
Pressing the button during photo recording will switch  
between “Off” and “40×”*1  
If you set zoom to “240×”*2 when recording photo, the  
digital zoom will be up to “40×”*1  
:
Choose the desired magnification, and then  
press the A button.  
.
.
When a subject is zoomed, it may be momentarily out  
of focus.  
When digital zoom is engaged, the image quality will  
be rougher.  
*1 “60×” on DZ-BX31A.  
*2 “1,000×” on DZ-BX31A.  
57  
MACRO RECORDING  
Use the macro function when recording a small object from close-up position: You can shoot the  
subject as close as approximately 13/16” (2 cm) from the lens surface, magnifying the image to fill  
the screen.  
1
Aim the DVD video camera/recorder at the  
subject, and press the zoom lever to “W”  
control side.  
Note:  
Zoom can be used, but the subject may not be  
focused, depending on the distance to the subject. In  
this case, move the zoom to “W” control side to focus.  
The amount of light tends to be insufficient during  
macro recording: If the subject image is too dark, use  
additional lighting.  
RECORDING SUBJECTS FOR STRONGER WIDE-ANGLE OR TELEPHOTO  
EFFECT  
Use the tele-conversion lens or wide-conversion lens with the following filter diameter and thread  
pitch to record subjects for stronger telephoto or wide-angle effect:  
Filter diameter: 34 mm for DZ-GX20MA, DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A; 30.5 mm for DZ-  
MV780MA  
Thread pitch: 0.5 mm  
When attaching the optional DZ-TL1 tele-conversion lens or DZ-WL1 wide-conversion lens, use the  
optional step-up ring: DZ-SR3437 for DZ-GX20MA, DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A; DZ-SR3037 for  
DZ-MV780MA (see page 162).  
1
Remove the lens hood from DVD video  
camera/recorder, and attach the step-up ring  
over the lens.  
2
Remove the cap of conversion lens, and screw  
the lens into the thread of step-up ring.  
Lens hood  
Conversion lens  
Step-up ring  
(Remove)  
(Attach)  
Tele-conversion lens: For stronger telephoto effect  
Wide-conversion lens: For stronger wide-angle effect  
Note:  
Be careful not to lose the removed lens hood.  
With DZ-TL1 tele-conversion lens, the focusing range  
at “T” (telephoto) control side is between approx.  
16 feet (5 m) and infinite.  
When a conversion lens is attached, note that the four  
corners of screen will be slightly dim if you zoom in on  
a subject on the W control side (wide-angle side).  
When replacing the lens, take care not to drop the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
Attaching the conversion lens will disable the function  
of the built-in flash (for DZ-GX20MA only): Specify  
“Flash: Off” (see page 79).  
If a generally available filter is attached, do not attach  
the removed lens hood.  
58  
Playing Back  
Insert a disc or card recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder (p. 50,  
52).  
Before You Begin  
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder on (p. 45).  
1<>23  
PLAYING BACK  
Playing Back  
Note:  
If the LCD monitor is open during playback of movie,  
playback sound will be heard from the speaker. Adjust  
the sound volume using the volume control buttons  
(S, R).  
STOP/EXIT  
To temporarily stop playback, press the A button.  
Press the A button again to restart playback.  
Even if you stop playback midway and immediately  
start recording again, the new image will be recorded  
after the last scene on disc or card (the previous  
images will not be overwritten).  
Image data edited on PC, etc., or the recorded image  
may not appear on this DVD video camera/recorder;  
also, the recorded sound may not play back,  
depending on the type of image data.  
Use f / e / d / c to select,  
and then press A to designate.  
Image data recorded on another DVD video camera/  
recorder or DVD recorder may not be played on this  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
Depending on the amount of data to be played back,  
it may take some time for the playback image to  
appear.  
1
Press the A button in the recording pause  
status.  
Do not operate the power switch or remove the card  
while the ACCESS/PC or CARD ACCESS indicator is  
lit or blinking: Doing so may damage the card or the  
data on card.  
The DVD video camera/recorder will enter  
the playback mode, and the scene you have  
recorded last will be played back. (For  
“scene”, see p. 106 and “Terminology”,  
p. 166.)  
When playback is finished, the DVD video  
camera/recorder will enter the pause status  
at the last image on disc.  
If the playback pause status continues for as  
long as 5 minutes, the DVD video camera/  
recorder will automatically return to the  
recording pause status.  
2
Press the C button.  
Playback will stop, and recording pause  
status will be restored.  
59  
1<>23  
PLAYBACK FROM START OF DISC OR CARD  
Use the Go To function (p. 62) or Disc  
Navigation function (p. 106) to play back from  
the start of disc or card.  
1<>2  
SEARCH PLAYBACK OF MOVIE  
During playback, press the d or c button and  
hold it: Search playback will start.  
Note:  
See “Check 3” on page 169 if search playback does  
not operate normally.  
Hold down c :  
Scenes will be visually scanned forward.  
Hold down d :  
Scenes will be visually scanned backward.  
Release the d or c button when you find the  
desired image:  
Normal playback will start from that point.  
1<>2  
FRAME ADVANCE/FRAME BACK/SLOW PLAYBACK OF MOVIE  
During playback pause, press the d or c  
button: Frame advance, frame back or slow  
playback will start.  
After frame advance, frame back or slow  
playback, the DVD video camera/recorder will  
enter the playback pause status.  
Note:  
Press c once:  
In slow playback, a rapidly moving subject image may  
be distorted.  
The intervals for playing back frames in frame  
advance/frame back/slow playback are as follows:  
Frame advance and forward slow: Approx. 0.03  
second  
Frame back and reverse slow: Approx. 0.5 second  
No sound will be heard during search playback or  
slow playback.  
Picture will advance one frame.  
Press d once:  
Picture will go back one frame.  
Hold down c :  
Forward slow playback.  
Hold down d :  
Reverse slow playback.  
60  
1<>2  
SKIP PLAYBACK OF MOVIE  
During playback, press the f or e button to  
locate the start of desired scene.  
Portion being played back  
Press e once:  
Press f  
Press f Press e Press e  
To skip to the first image of the scene  
following the one being played back, and start  
playback.  
twice  
once once  
twice  
Scene 1  
Scene 2  
Scene 3  
Press f once:  
To return to the first image of the scene being  
played back, and start playback.  
Hold down e :  
Portion being played back  
Press f  
Press e  
Press e  
To continuously locate the beginnings of  
scenes, starting from the scene following the  
scene being played back. When the desired  
image appears, release the button: Playback  
will start from that point.  
once  
once  
twice  
Scene 1  
Scene 2  
Scene 3  
Pressing the f button at a portion several seconds  
from the start of scene being played back will return  
to the start of the scene preceding that being played  
back.  
Hold down f :  
To continuously locate the beginnings of  
scenes backward, starting from the scene  
preceding the scene currently being played  
back. When the desired image appears, release  
the button: Playback will start from that point.  
Note:  
If you perform skip playback during playback pause,  
the DVD video camera/recorder will enter the  
playback pause status at the beginning of the located  
scene.  
Pressing the e button in the last scene on disc will  
set the DVD video camera/recorder to the playback  
pause status at the last image.  
See “Check 3” on page 169 if skip playback does not  
operate normally.  
13  
PLAYING BACK STILLS  
Press the f or e button during playback to  
quickly play back stills in sequence.  
[When using disc]  
Releasing the f or e button will start  
continuous playback.  
Press e once:  
To display stills one by one forward.  
Press f once:  
To display stills one by one backward.  
[When using card]  
When the f or e button is released, the  
photo at that point will be displayed, and then  
the DVD video camera/recorder will enter the  
playback pause status.  
Set the slide show function for continuous  
display (p. 140).  
61  
1<>23  
JUMPING TO SPECIFIED POINT (GO TO)  
1
2
Press the MENU button  
during playback.  
Top:  
To go to the start, and enter playback pause.  
End:  
To go to the end of last scene, and enter  
playback pause.  
Go To  
To p  
En d  
Spec  
i
f
y
Choose the option  
(point you want to go  
to), and then press the  
A button.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Specify:  
To go to a specified point and enter playback  
pause. See the following for details.  
Specifying the point to view  
1
Choose “Specify” in step 2 above, and then  
press the A button.  
3
Press the A button to enter the selection.  
The DVD video camera/recorder will go to  
the specified point and enter the playback  
pause status.  
The screen for specifying the point to go to  
will appear.  
Pressing A again will start playback.  
Position of currently  
played back image  
Total recording time of  
all selected scenes  
To cancel the “Go To” procedure midway, press  
the C button before going to the specified point.  
Go  
t
o
TOP  
0: 00: 00  
CURRENT  
0: 03 : 26  
END  
0: 24 : 24  
Note:  
Cursor  
If multiple scenes are selected using the Disc  
Navigation function or SELECT button, choosing  
Top” will jump to the beginning of selected scenes  
(p. 134).  
When multiple scenes are selected, the total time of  
selected scenes will appear in the “total recording  
time” display.  
With card, the number of stills will appear at the  
“TOP”, “CURRENT”, “END” and “GO TO” indicators.  
The cursor may not move at same-pitch intervals.  
GO T0: 03 : 26  
TOP END ETER  
CANCEL  
Cursor position  
2
Use the f/e/d/c buttons to select  
the desired time of chosen point.  
Press f  
Press e  
Press d or c  
Press once:  
:
:
:
To select the start.  
To select the end.  
To move the cursor in 10-second units  
(1-still units for card)  
Hold down:  
To move the cursor in 1-minute units  
(10-still units for card)  
Go  
t
o
TOP  
0: 00: 00  
CURRENT  
0: 03 : 26  
END  
0: 24 : 24  
GO TO 0: 00 : 00  
TOP END ENTER  
CANCEL  
(When the start of scene is selected)  
( Cursor at current image position.  
) Cursor at (GO TO) position.  
62  
1<>23  
On-Screen Information Display  
INFORMATION DISPLAY DURING PLAYBACK  
Various types of information on recording will be superimposed on playback image you are viewing.  
RAM  
9:27  
A
M
9/ 30/2006  
No display  
Playback information  
display  
Recording date/time  
*1  
Switching the information display  
mode  
Press the DISPLAY button: You can switch the  
display mode of on-screen information.  
O (VIDEO) or N (PHOTO) with disc;  
Only E (PHOTO) with card.  
8 Program or 5 Play List  
Number of program or play list being played  
back (not displayed when all programs are  
being played back)  
*2  
*3  
When using disc:  
*4  
*5  
Refer to “Disc/Card type” on page 55.  
Recording mode*1  
Y
: Will appear when each function is  
specified “On”  
Scene No.  
Repeat play*5  
*6  
F
: Standard playback  
b
c
d
: Playback pause  
: Forward search playback  
: Reverse search playback  
06  
006  
0 : 00 : 16  
RAM  
Playback  
e : Forward skip playback  
f : Reverse skip playback  
operation*6  
g
h
: Forward frame advance  
: Reverse frame back  
Counter  
Disc type*4  
Program No. or Play List No.*3  
Refer to “Playing Back” beginning on page 59  
for how to operate.  
The “j” mark will appear on the first image  
on disc.  
Program or Play List*2  
The “i” mark will appear on the last image  
on disc.  
When using card:  
Scene No.  
File name  
Lock*5  
Recording date/time display: Shows the date/  
time when recording was started. Even when  
playback starts, the date/time display will not  
advance.  
No display: No information will appear.  
However, when the mode of playback  
operation is switched, the symbol will appear  
for approx. 3 seconds.  
Slide Show*5  
003  
100—0003  
Recording mode*1  
Playback operation*6  
Note:  
See “Using Disc Navigation” on page 106 and later for  
explanation on program and play list.  
63  
Checking Flow of Quick Menu  
The following two on-screen menu modes are available with this DVD video camera/recorder:  
• Quick Menu: To display only the fundamental menu items for first timers  
• Normal Menu: To display all menu items for experts (p. 87)  
Camera Functions  
While the camera image is being displayed on the LCD monitor, press the QUICK MENU button:  
The Quick Menu will appear.  
Only the fundamental menu items will appear in the Quick Menu, and the explanation of the  
function on which the cursor is positioned will be displayed across the bottom of menu (No  
explanation on function will appear in the Normal Menu).  
Use the f/e/d/c buttons to select a menu item, and then press the A button to choose  
the option.  
See “Operating Menu” shown below for how to set the menu.  
No menu appears during recording.  
1
Press the QUICK MENU button.  
<How to interpret the menu screen>  
Q u  
i
c k  
M
e n u  
V I DEO  
M
o d e  
F I NE  
Options settable  
1 6  
:
9
I
n p u  
t
S o u r c e  
Selection of setup items  
S e  
l
e c  
t
t
h e  
m
o v  
i
e
q u a  
l
i
t
y .  
T : Record Functions Setup  
U : Date Setup  
Display of disc or card being  
used (p. 55)  
W
: Initial Setup  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
Guide display  
Functions settable  
Explanation on function  
64  
Operating Menu  
You can use the f/e/d/c buttons on DVD video camera/recorder to select various setting  
options in Quick Menu and designate them.  
Press the QUICK MENU button.  
QUICK  
MENU  
Press c or A  
Q u  
i
c
f
k
V
1
I
M
DEO  
:
p
e
n
u
c
Q u  
i
c
t
k
V
1
I
M
DEO  
:
p
e
n
u
I
6
n
M
o
d
u
d
e
r
:
:
:
F
O
CA  
I
f
NE  
f
I
6
n
M
o
d
u
i
e
r
F
i
I
t
NE  
y .  
9
u
9
u
t
S o  
c
f
e
u
M
ERA  
t
S o  
c
e
q
M
s
e
e
n
t
u
u
o
r
r
e
o
r
n
c
t
i
o
n
s
S e  
l
e
c
t
h
e
m
o
v
e
u
a
l
p.  
Press d or C  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RAM  
Press e  
Press f  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
a
u
Press the A button directly to choose an option from menu.  
To return to the screen one before, press the C button.  
Pressing the QUICK MENU button again will cause the Quick  
Menu display to disappear.  
D a  
S e  
t
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
t
e
s
e
t
u
p
.
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
When using the Normal Menu (p. 88) and Disc Navigation Menu (p. 111), use the same procedure to  
choose any menu item and determine the option.  
Note:  
Pressing the QUICK MENU button during recording will not work.  
The menu screen will disappear when it is left for approx. one minute without any operation.  
65  
1<>2  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING MOVIE:  
The following shows the menu when DVD-RAM disc is being used:  
The details of each function are described on the pages showing the Normal Menu: See each  
reference page.  
Record Functions Setup  
(p. 94)  
Q u  
i
c
k
V
1
I
M
DEO  
:
p
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
V
1
I
M
DEO  
:
p
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
V
1
I
M
DEO  
:
p
e
n
u
I
6
n
M
o
d
u
d
e
r
:
:
:
F
O
CA  
I
f
NE  
f
I
6
n
M
o
d
u
i
e
r
F
i
I
t
NE  
y .  
I
6
n
M
o
d
u
l
e
r
X T RA  
9
u
9
u
9
u
F
I
NE  
t
S o  
c
f
e
u
M
ERA  
t
S o  
c
e
q
t
S o  
c
t
e
S T D  
M
s
e
e
n
t
u
u
f
o
r
r
e
c
o
r
n
c
t
i
o
n
s
S e  
l
e
c
t
t
h
e
m
o
v
e
u
a
l
F
i
n
e
I
m
a
g
e
Q u  
a
i
y .  
p.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RA  
M
M
M
RAM  
(p. 95)  
Q u  
i
c
k
V
1
I
M
e
n
u
s
Q u  
i
c
k
V
1
I
M
e
n
u
y
I
6
n
DEO  
M
o
d
u
e
e
r
I
6
n
DEO  
M
o
d
u
:
e
r
:
p
9
u
O
f
f
:
p
9
u
O n  
t
i
S o  
s
c
e
t
S o  
4
c
.
e
O
f
f
1
6
:
9
m
o
d
e
t
.
R e  
c
o
r
d
i
n
g
b
3
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
RAM  
(p. 97)  
Q u  
i
c
t
k
V
1
I
M
e
n
u
r
Q u  
i
l
c
l
k
V
1
I
M
e
n
u
e
I
6
n
DEO  
M
o
d
u
e
e
r
I
6
n
DEO  
M
o
d
u
e
r
:
p
9
u
:
p
9
u
CA  
M
NE  
L
o
ERA  
t
S o  
c
v
e
i
CA  
M
a
ERA  
t
l
S o  
c
e
L
S
t
I
I
NE  
n.  
*
S e  
l
e
c
t
h
e
e
c
i
n
g
i
m
g
e.  
U s  
u
a
y
s
e
c
t
t
h
i
s
o
p
i
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
RAM  
* Displayed on DZ-GX20MA  
and DZ-MV780MA only.  
Date Setup  
(p. 38)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
r
u
D a  
S e  
t
D a  
e
S e  
t
9
t
/
3
0
8
/
:
2
0
0
0 A  
0
6
M
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
a
t
e
s
e
t
u
p.  
S e  
t
t
h
c
u
r
e
n
t
d
a
e
a
n
d
t
i
m
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RA  
M
66  
Initial Setup  
(p. 104)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
E n  
g
a
p
u
a
l
n
a
t
i
s
a
o
c
a
h
i
l
h
n
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
I
a
M
g
o
e
d
:
:
E n  
A u  
g
t
l
o
i
s
h
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
E n  
e
g
d
l
i
i
s
h
l
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
F
E
r
s
ç
ñ
s
i
s
e
a
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
t
n
D e  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
i
t
i
l
s
e
t
u
p.  
C h  
a
n
g
e
h
l
a
n
u
a
g
s
p
a
y .  
C h  
a
n
g
e
h
l
a
n
u
I
t
l
o
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RAM  
RAM  
(p. 165)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
m
3
g
o
e
o
a
M
g
o
e
d
A u  
t
f
a
f
o
D e  
R e  
d
e
r
A u  
t
o
e
O
S
f
t
t
o
t
n
m
r
t
t
S e  
l
e
t
c
i
t
n
e
m
n
s
t
a
t
i
o
n
m
o
d
e
S
a
t
p
a
p
r
r
t
o
d
e
s
i
t
n
r
u
a
t
t
e
i
o
n
a
e
r
s
e
t
g.  
x .  
s .  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
(p. 105)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
L
D e  
R e  
e
l
a
n
m
s
u
s
g
o
e
p
t
a
M
g
o
e
d
e
M
i
e
n
n
i
u
t
s
a
t
i
t
s
e
r
e
e
x
t
c
u
e
r
p
n
t
e
d
d
t
t
o
e.  
i
a
a
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
1
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING PHOTO (DISC):  
The following shows the menu when DVD-RAM disc is being used:  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
Record Functions Setup  
(p. 97)  
Q u  
i
c
k
I
S e  
M
p
l
e
u
f
n
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
I
S e  
M
p
l
e
u
f
n
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
I
S e  
M
p
l
e
u
f
n
t
u
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
e
:
:
CA  
M
f
ERA  
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
v
e
i
CA  
M
a
ERA  
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
e
i
CA  
M
NE  
L
ERA  
T
i
m
O
f
T
i
m
T
i
m
L
I
S
I
NE  
*
M
s
e
e
n
t
u
u
f
o
r
r
e
c
o
r
d
f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
s
S e  
l
e
c
t
t
h
e
r
e
c
e
i
n
g
i
m
g
e.  
U s  
u
a
l
l
y
s
e
l
e
c
t
t
h
s
o
p
t
i
o
n.  
p.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RAM  
RA  
M
* Displayed on DZ-GX20MA  
and DZ-MV780MA only.  
(p. 99)  
Q u  
i
c
t
k
I
S e  
M
p
l
e
u
f
n
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
I
S e  
M
p
l
e
u
f
n
t
u
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
t
e
i
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
t
e
i
T
i
m
O
.
f
f
T
i
m
O n  
O
f
f
S e  
l
e
c
t
h
e
s
e
l
f
m
e
r
C a  
n
c
c
o
e
r
l
d
t
n
h
g.  
e
s
e
l
f
m
e
r
r
e
i
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
67  
Date Setup  
(p. 38)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
r
u
D a  
S e  
t
D a  
S e  
t
9
t
/
3
0
8
/
:
2
0
0
0 A  
0
6
M
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
a
t
e
s
e
t
u
p.  
S e  
t
t
h
e
c
u
r
e
n
t
d
a
e
a
n
d
t
i
m
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
Initial Setup  
(p. 104)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
E n  
g
a
p
u
a
l
n
a
t
i
s
a
o
c
a
h
i
l
h
n
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
I
a
M
g
o
e
d
:
:
E n  
A u  
g
t
l
o
i
s
h
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
E n  
e
g
d
l
i
i
s
h
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
F
E
r
s
ç
ñ
s
i
s
e
a
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
t
n
D e  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
i
t
i
l
s
e
t
u
p.  
C h  
a
n
g
e
he  
l
a
n
u
a
g
s
p
l
a
y .  
C h  
a
n
g
e
h
l
a
n
u
I
t
l
o
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RA  
M
RA  
M
(p. 165)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
m
3
g
o
e
o
a
M
g
o
e
d
A u  
t
f
a
f
o
D e  
R e  
d
e
r
A u  
t
o
e
O
S
f
t
t
o
t
n
m
r
t
t
S e  
l
e
t
c
i
t
n
e
m
n
s
t
a
t
i
o
n
m
o
d
e
S
a
t
p
a
p
r
r
t
o
d
e
s
i
t
n
r
u
a
t
t
e
i
o
n
a
e
r
s
e
t
g.  
x .  
s .  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
RAM  
(p. 105)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
L
D e  
R e  
e
l
a
n
m
s
u
s
g
o
e
p
t
a
M
g
o
e
d
e
M
i
e
n
n
i
u
t
s
a
t
i
t
s
e
r
e
e
x
t
c
u
e
r
p
n
t
e
d
d
t
t
o
e.  
i
a
a
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RA  
M
Note:  
No photo can be recorded on DVD-RW/DVD-R disc.  
68  
3
FLOW OF QUICK MENU WHEN RECORDING PHOTO (CARD):  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
Record Functions Setup  
(p. 97)  
Q u  
i
c
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
Q u  
i
c
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
Q u  
i
c
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
y
S o  
i
F
i
I
t
NE  
y .  
y
S o  
i
F
I
NE  
y
S o  
i
:
:
:
F
CA  
O
i
I
NE  
n
u
e
r
r
c
f
e
u
M
f
ERA  
n
u
e
r
r
c
e
q
n
u
e
r
r
c
t
e
NOR  
ECO  
M
S e  
T
c
m
f
S e  
T
p
m
S e  
T
m
M
s
e
e
n
t
u
u
f
o
r
r
e
o
r
d
n
c
t
o
n
s
S e  
l
e
c
t
t
h
e
h
o
t
o
u
a
l
F
i
n
e
I
m
a
g
e
Q u  
a
l
i
y .  
p.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
(p. 97)  
Q u  
i
c
t
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
Q u  
i
l
c
l
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
y
S o  
i
y
n
u
e
r
r
c
v
e
i
CA  
M
a
ERA  
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
e
CA  
M
NE  
L
o
ERA  
S e  
T
r
m
S e  
T
e
i
m
L
S
t
I
I
NE  
*
S e  
l
e
c
t
h
e
e
c
e
i
n
g
i
m
g
e.  
U s  
u
a
y
s
e
l
c
t
t
h
i
s
o
p
i
n.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
* Displayed on DZ-GX20MA  
and DZ-MV780MA only.  
(p. 99)  
Q u  
i
c
t
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
Q u  
i
c
k
Q u  
I
M
a
p
l
e
l
u
f
n
i
t
u
t
y
S o  
i
y
n
u
e
r
r
c
t
e
i
n
S o  
u
e
r
r
c
t
e
i
S e  
T
s
m
O
.
f
f
S e  
T
s
i
m
O n  
O
f
f
S e  
l
e
c
t
h
e
e
l
f
m
e
r
C a  
n
c
c
o
e
r
l
d
t
n
h
g.  
e
e
l
f
m
e
r
r
e
i
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
Date Setup  
(p. 38)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
t
e
e
n
r
u
D a  
S e  
t
D a  
S e  
t
9
t
/
3
0
8
/
:
2
0
0
0 A  
0
6
M
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
a
t
e
s
e
t
u
p.  
S e  
t
t
h
e
c
u
r
e
n
t
d
a
e
a
n
d
t
i
m
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
69  
Initial Setup  
(p. 104)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
E n  
g
a
p
u
a
l
n
a
t
i
s
a
o
c
a
h
i
l
h
n
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
I
a
M
g
o
e
d
:
:
E n  
A u  
g
t
l
o
i
s
h
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
E n  
e
g
d
l
i
i
s
h
l
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
F
E
r
s
ç
ñ
s
i
s
e
a
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
D e  
R e  
t
e
g
t
n
D e  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
i
t
i
l
s
e
t
u
p.  
C h  
a
n
g
e
h
l
a
n
u
a
g
s
p
a
y .  
C h  
a
n
g
e
h
l
a
n
u
I
t
l
o
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
(p. 165)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
u
E n  
g
o
l
i
s
h
E n  
g
o
l
i
s
h
L
a
n
m
s
g
o
e
a
M
g
o
e
d
L
D e  
R e  
a
n
m
s
m
3
g
o
e
o
a
M
ge  
A u  
f
t
t
f
a
f
D e  
R e  
d
e
r
A u  
t
o
o
de  
O
S
t
o
t
n
m
r
t
t
e
S e  
l
e
t
c
i
t
n
e
m
n
s
t
a
t
i
o
n
m
d
e
S
a
t
p
a
p
r
r
t
o
d
e
s
i
t
n
r
u
a
t
t
e
i
o
n
a
r
s
e
t
g.  
x .  
s .  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
(p. 105)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
t
u
E n  
g
l
i
s
h
L
D e  
R e  
e
l
a
n
m
s
u
s
g
o
e
p
t
a
M
g
o
e
d
e
M
i
e
n
n
i
u
t
s
a
t
i
t
s
e
r
e
e
x
t
c
u
e
r
p
n
t
e
d
d
t
t
o
e.  
i
a
a
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
Disc Navigation Functions  
While Disc Navigation screen is being displayed on the LCD monitor, press the QUICK MENU  
button: The Quick Menu will appear.  
Only the fundamental menu items will appear in the Quick Menu, and the explanation of the  
function on which the cursor is positioned will be displayed across the bottom of menu (except  
during recording).  
1
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
2
Select a scene, and then press the QUICK  
MENU button.  
70  
1
FLOW OF QUICK MENU (WITH DVD-RAM DISC):  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
Scene  
(p. 115)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
C o  
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
y
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
C o  
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
y
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
C o  
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
y
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
f
c
c
t
f
c
t
f
c
t
ETC  
ETC  
ETC  
p
p
p
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
s
e
n
e.  
E d  
i
t
s
c
e
n
e.  
D
i
v
i
d
e
s
c
e
n
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
RAM  
(p. 113)  
Q u  
i
c
k
t
M
E d  
E
C o  
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
y
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
f
c
t
ETC  
p
D e  
l
e
e
s
e
l
e
c
t
e
d
s
c
e
n
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
(p. 117)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
e
n
i
u
t
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
e
n
i
u
t
E
C o  
f
f
p
e
y
c
c
t
t
F
a
s
d
e
e
t
E
C o  
f
f
p
e
y
c
t
F
a
d
n
e
b
ETC  
ETC  
S
c
e
n
e
e
f
f
e
i
s
u
p.  
A d  
d
d
f
o
a
r
d
i
e
n
n
g
d
t
o
o
f
t
s
h
c
e
e
e
g
i
n
n
i
n
g
a
n
/
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
(p. 120)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
e
n
i
u
t
E
C o  
f
f
p
e
y
c
t
l
ETC  
C o  
p
y
c
t
r
h
d.  
e
s
e
e
c
t
e
d
p
h
o
t
o
t
o
a
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
Disc  
(p. 135)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
F
e
o
n
r
u
Q u  
i
c
c
k
M
F
e
o
n
r
u
m
a
i
t
D
i
s
c
m
a
t
t
D
i
s
c
ETC  
ETC  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
s
c .  
D
i
s
F
o
r
m
a
.
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
Others  
(p. 139)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
c
k
M
e
n
u
ETC  
ETC  
ETC  
R e  
M
p
e
e
n
a
u
t
P
l
a
y
:
O
f
f
R e  
p
h
e
e
a
t
P
p
l
a
a
y
t
O
a
f
f
R e  
r
p
e
e
p
a
e
t
P
l
a
l
y
O n  
O
f
f
O
t
h
e
r
s
S e  
l
t
e
t
c
i
t
n
t
r
e
e
p
l
y
C a  
n
e
l
a
t
p
a
y .  
s
e
g.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
RAM  
RAM  
RAM  
71  
<>  
FLOW OF QUICK MENU (WITH DVD-RW DISC):  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
Scene  
(p. 115)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
E
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
f
c
c
t
f
c
t
f
c
t
ETC  
ETC  
ETC  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
s
e
n
e.  
E d  
i
t
s
c
e
n
e.  
D
i
v
i
d
e
s
c
e
n
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
(p. 113)  
Q u  
i
c
k
t
M
E d  
E
e
n
i
f
u
t
e
D
D e  
i
v
l
i
e
d
t
e
e
f
c
t
ETC  
D e  
l
e
e
s
e
l
e
c
t
e
d
s
c
e
n
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
(p. 117)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
e
n
i
u
t
Q u  
i
c
k
M
E d  
e
n
i
u
t
E
f
f
e
c
c
t
t
F
a
s
d
e
e
t
E
f
f
e
c
t
F
a
d
n
e
b
ETC  
ETC  
S
c
e
n
e
e
f
f
e
i
s
u
p.  
A d  
d
d
f
o
a
r
d
i
e
n
n
g
d
t
o
o
f
t
s
h
c
e
e
e
g
i
n
n
i
n
g
a
n
/
e.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
Disc  
(p. 138)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
l
M
e
n
u
F
F
i
o
n
r
a
m
l
a
i
t
z
e
D
D
s
i
c
s
c
F
F
i
o
n
r
a
m
l
a
i
t
z
e
D
D
s
i
c
s
c
)
ETC  
ETC  
i
i
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
i
s
c .  
F
i
n
a
i
z
e
DVD  
-
R
W
(
VR  
d
i
s
c .  
*
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
* "Finalize DVD-RW (VF) disc"  
will appear when DVD-RW  
(VF-mode) is used.  
(p. 135)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
F
F
i
o
n
r
a
m
l
a
i
t
z
e
D
D
s
i
c
s
c
ETC  
i
D
i
s
c
F
o
r
m
a
t
.
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
72  
Others  
(p. 139)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
u
Q u  
i
c
c
k
M
e
n
u
ETC  
ETC  
ETC  
R e  
M
p
e
e
n
a
u
t
P
l
a
y
:
O
f
f
R e  
p
h
e
e
a
t
P
p
l
a
a
y
t
O
a
f
f
R e  
r
p
e
e
p
a
e
t
P
l
a
l
y
O n  
O
f
f
O
t
h
e
r
s
S e  
l
t
e
t
c
i
t
n
t
r
e
e
p
l
y
C a  
n
e
l
a
t
p
a
y .  
s
e
g.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
R
W
VR  
Note:  
The Scene menu will not appear in the VF mode.  
“Finalize Disc” in the Disc menu will not appear with a previously finalized DVD-RW disc.  
2
FLOW OF QUICK MENU (WITH DVD-R DISC):  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
Disc  
(p. 138)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
F
e
i
n
n
u
a
Q u  
i
c
k
M
F
e
i
n
n
u
a
l
i
i
z
e
D
i
s
c
l
i
z
-
e
D
d
i
i
s
s
c
ETC  
ETC  
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
d
s
c .  
F
i
n
a
l
i
z
e
DVD  
R
c .  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
R
Others  
(p. 139)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
p
u
e
Q u  
i
c
k
M
e
n
p
u
e
Q u  
i
c
c
k
M
e
n
p
u
e
ETC  
ETC  
ETC  
R e  
a
u
t
P
l
a
y
:
O
f
f
R e  
a
t
P
p
l
a
a
y
t
O
a
f
f
R e  
r
a
e
t
P
l
a
l
y
O n  
O
f
f
O
t
h
e
r
s
M
e
n
S e  
l
t
e
t
c
i
t
n
t
h
e
r
e
e
p
l
y
C a  
n
e
l
e
p
a
t
p
a
y .  
s
e
g.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
R
R
R
Note:  
The menu item “Finalize Disc” will not appear with a finalized DVD-R disc.  
73  
3
FLOW OF QUICK MENU (WITH CARD):  
The details of each function are described on pages showing the Normal Menu: See each reference  
page.  
(p. 113)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
D e  
e
n
l
u
e
Q u  
D e  
i
c
k
M
D e  
e
n
l
u
e
t
e
t
e
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
s
c
e
n
e.  
l
e
t
e
s
e
l
e
c
t
e
d
p
h
o
t
o.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
(p. 135)  
Q u  
i
c
k
M
F
e
o
n
r
u
Q u  
C a  
i
c
k
M
F
e
o
n
r
u
m
a
a
t
C a  
r
d
m
a
t
t
C a  
r
d
M
e
n
u
f
o
r
c
r
d.  
r
d
F
o
r
m
a
.
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
(p. 140)  
Q u  
i
i
c
k
M
e
n
a
u
r
Q u  
i
c
r
k
t
M
e
n
u
S
s
t
t
S
s
t
l
a
i
r
t
S
l
d
e
h
o w  
o
f
a
l
l
s
c
e
n
e
s .  
S
t
a
d
e
s
h
o w.  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
EN T ER  
RE T URN  
74  
1<>23  
Manually Focusing Subject  
The DVD video camera/recorder usually focuses on a subject automatically (autofocus). You can also  
manually focus a subject depending on the recording conditions.  
FOCUSING DURING RECORDING  
Normally, the DVD video camera/recorder automatically focuses the subject (autofocus), but you  
can also manually focus a subject, depending on the recording conditions (manual focus).  
Focusing range  
You can switch the display mode of on-screen information:  
On T (tele) side: approximately 3.2 feet (1 m) from lens surface to infinity  
On W (wide) side: approximately 13/16" (2 cm) from lens surface to infinity  
1
Press the FOCUS button during recording.  
“MF” will appear on the screen.  
Manual Focus icon  
VOL.  
FOCUS  
Adjust with S and R buttons  
2
3
Press the zoom lever to “T” control side to  
zoom in on subject.  
Use the S R buttons to adjust the focus,  
while viewing the image in the viewfinder or  
on the LCD screen.  
Note:  
Pressing FOCUS will alternate between manual focus  
and auto focus. With auto focus, no indication will  
appear on the screen.  
Be sure to zoom in on your subject before manually  
focusing on it. If you bring the subject into focus at the  
“W” control side, focus will be faulty when you turn the  
zoom lever to the “T” control side to zoom in on the  
subject.  
Manual focus is released when the DVD video  
camera/recorder is turned off. When you turn the DVD  
video camera/recorder on next time, auto focus will be  
restored.  
75  
Manually focus the following objects, which may not be automatically focused (see page 75):  
Objects not in  
the center of  
screen  
Objects with  
little variation  
in brightness,  
such as white  
wall  
Objects that  
are far and  
near at the  
same time  
Objects  
moving rapidly  
Objects lit by  
neon sign,  
spotlight, etc.  
which glares  
or emits  
Dark objects  
strong light  
Object behind  
glass with  
water  
Night view  
droplets, dirt  
on it  
76  
1<>23  
Adjusting Brightness of Image to be recorded  
(Exposure)  
The DVD video camera/recorder usually adjusts the exposure automatically. You can also manually  
adjust the exposure depending on the recording conditions.  
1
Press the EXPOSURE button during  
recording.  
VOL.  
EXPOSURE  
The exposure adjustment bar will appear on  
the screen.  
Adjust with S and R buttons  
Exposure adjustment bar  
Note:  
Pressing EXPOSURE will alternate between manual  
adjustment and auto exposure. With auto exposure,  
no indication will appear on the screen.  
The exposure setting will return to Auto when the  
DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
2
Use the S R buttons to adjust the exposure,  
while viewing the image in the viewfinder or  
on the LCD screen.  
1<>23  
Compensating for Backlight  
When subject is lighted from rear, this function will compensate for lighting so that the subject is not  
too dark.  
BLC  
1
Press the BLC button during recording.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
Backlight correction icon  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
The backlight correction icon will appear.  
Note:  
Pressing the BLC button will alternate between  
backlight setting between on and off.  
The backlight setting will automatically return to “off”  
when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
77  
1<>2  
Using External Microphone  
Connect external microphone (generally available) to the external microphone jack of this DVD  
video camera/recorder. Clearer sound can be recorded. Turn on the switch on external microphone  
and start recording. For details on external microphone, see “Major Specifications” on page 186.  
To external  
microphone jack  
Note:  
Depending on the shape of its plug, an external microphone cannot be plugged in, while the cable is left plugged  
in the AV/S input/output terminal. Unplug the AV/S input/output cable to use the external microphone.  
This DVD video camera/recorder cannot use a plug-in power type microphone. (Power is not supplied from this  
DVD video camera/recorder.)  
78  
13  
Built-in Video Flash (for DZ-GX20MA only)  
When recording photos in a dark place, or if the subject is lit from rear, the DZ-GX20MA makes use of  
the built-in Video Flash for automatic brightening: The Video Flash can also be set to On where the light  
is always being emitted, or Off when you wish to record without using the flash even in a dark place.  
Setting  
On-screen display  
Manner of emitting light  
Automatically emits light in dark place or in a spot lit  
from rear.  
( when the PHOTO button is  
Auto  
pressed  
On  
Off  
Always emits light regardless of brightness.  
No light emission.  
(
)
1
Press the MENU button, and choose Flash  
from the Camera Functions Setup menu.  
Note:  
The built-in Video Flash setting will not change even  
when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Unless recording is to be made with the fixed Flash  
setting, it is recommended to return it to “Auto” after  
recording with the “On” or “Off” setting, before turning  
the DVD video camera/recorder off.  
2
3
Choose the option for Flash and decide it.  
Press the MENU  
Ca  
m
e r a F u nc  
P r og r a  
h i t e Ba l .  
D i o om  
t
i
on s Se t u p  
button to end the  
setting.  
m
AE  
When recording dark subjects, the shutter speed will  
be slower, so don’t let the camera shake.  
W
g
.
Z
F
l
a sh  
Au  
On  
Of  
t
f
o
However, dark subjects may not be in clear focus even  
if the Video Flash is used. It is recommended that you  
light a subject when recording in a dark place.  
The built-in Video Flash cannot be used when a  
conversion lens is attached: Specify “Flash: Off”.  
The Video Flash automatically adjusts the amount of  
light emitted, but the light amount adjustment may be  
insufficient when a subject is too far away or too near.  
If you continuously record using the Flash, the Flash  
may not emit light or the amount of light may not be  
adjustable. After recording using the Flash, it is  
recommended that you wait for a few moments,  
before pressing the PHOTO button to record.  
*
* Displayed when  
using DZ-  
GX20MA to  
record photo (not  
displayed when  
the optional Video  
Flash is  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
REM  
3
9
4
connected)  
8
0
:
0
0
AM  
9
/
3
/
2
0
0
6
The distance for the built-in Video Flash to adjust the  
appropriate amount of light will vary depending on the  
subject, but it is approximately 3.2 – 8.2 feet (1 – 2.5 m).  
When recording a close-up photo, specify Flash: Off.  
Using the flash too near subject could cause a whitish  
image.  
( ” will blink during charging of the battery for Video  
Flash.  
Optional Video Flash (for DZ-  
GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only)  
See “Introduction to Optional Accessories” on  
page 162.  
While “ ( ” is flashing, the video flash will not emit  
light, though the DVD camera/recorder is recording.  
You can use the optional DZ-FLH3 Video Flash*  
(p. 162): Refer to the instruction manual of Video  
Flash for use.  
Do not use the Video Flash when approaching the  
human eye. Emitting light from Video Flash near human  
eye could damage the subject’s eyesight. Especially  
when recording a baby or small child, move the DVD  
video camera/recorder at least 3.2 feet (1 m) away.  
* Unavailable for DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A.  
Do not use the Video Flash while pointing it at a driver  
in vehicle: Doing so could dazzle the driver, causing  
an accident.  
Do not use the Video Flash in a place where there is  
flammable or explosive gas: Doing so could cause fire  
or explosion.  
When the DZ-FLH3 is attached to DZ-GX20MA, the  
built-in video flash in DZ-GX20MA will not operate.  
79  
1<>23  
Viewing on TV Screen  
Connecting to  
a
TV  
CONNECTING TO A TV  
Use the provided AV/S input/output cable to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to a TV as  
follows:  
To S-VIDEO  
input jack*  
To video/audio  
input jacks  
To AV input/output jack  
Red  
AV/S input/output cable  
(provided)  
White  
Yellow  
* If your TV has an S-VIDEO input jack, you can connect the S-VIDEO plug to it.  
Note:  
Using S-VIDEO will deliver clearer playback status.  
Before connecting, make sure that the volume on TV  
is turned down: Forgetting this may cause howling  
(see “Terminology”, p. 166) from the TV speakers.  
Insert the AV/S input/output cable plugs into jacks  
straight: Obliquely inserting them could damage the  
jacks.  
Stereo Type with  
S-VIDEO Jack  
Stereo Type  
Monaural Type  
S-VIDEO  
AUDIO VIDEO  
L
AUDIO VIDEO  
L
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
R
White  
Yellow  
Red  
Yellow  
Red  
White  
White  
80  
1<>23  
VIEWING ON TV SCREEN  
1
Turn the TV on and set the input selector to  
“VCR” whichever applicable Video input.  
Note:  
Adjust the volume of sound on TV.  
The infrared remote control is useful when operating  
the DVD video camera/recorder while viewing an  
image on TV screen. However, if you use a Hitachi  
VCR, the remote control may inadvertently operate  
the VCR if it is near the DVD video camera/recorder.  
To prevent this, set the remote control code of the  
VCR to a position other than “VCR2”.  
Refer to the TV instruction manual for how to  
switch the TV input.  
2
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder on.  
Information that the DVD video camera/recorder is  
recording will appear on the TV screen: You can also  
display only part of information or switch off the  
display. Refer to “SETTING ON-SCREEN DISPLAY  
OUTPUT ON OR OFF (OSD OUTPUT)” on page 100,  
and press the DISPLAY button to switch the display  
status.  
The image that the DVD video camera/  
recorder is seeing will appear on the TV  
screen.  
You can also monitor the image on the LCD  
screen or viewfinder of the DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
When copy-guarded disc is played back, no image will  
appear on TV screen.  
3
Perform playback, recording or editing.  
If you use TV with wide mode (aspect ratio 16:9) and  
set the TV to the wide mode, the entire Disc  
Navigation display may not be displayed on the TV  
screen. If this happens, release the wide mode setting  
on TV (see the TV instruction manual for releasing the  
wide mode).  
You can perform playback, editing or editing  
on Disc Navigation while checking on TV  
screen.  
81  
1<>2  
Playback on DVD Recorder/Player  
PLAYING BACK DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) DISC  
You can use a DVD recorder (see “Terminology”, p. 166) or DVD player that conforms to DVD-RAM/  
DVD-RW (VR-mode) to play back 8 cm DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) discs recorded on this DVD  
video camera/recorder.  
1
Insert the disc into the DVD recorder/player  
and play it back.  
Note:  
When playing back disc on another device, the Disc  
Navigation display will be different from the one on  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
See the instruction manual for DVD  
recorder/player.  
Finalizing DVD-RW (VR-mode) may be necessary.  
Do not insert a DVD-RW (VR-mode) that was  
recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder into a  
device that does not conform to DVD-RW (VR-mode):  
Doing so may make the disc unusable.  
PLAYING BACK DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R DISC  
1
Finalize a recorded DVD-RW (VF-mode)/  
DVD-R disc.  
Note:  
Do not insert a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc that  
has not been finalized into any DVD recorder: The  
disc may be unusable (except for devices that allow  
playback of a DVD-R disc not finalized on this DVD  
video camera/recorder).  
You need to finalize (see “Terminology”,  
p. 166) a disc to play it back on DVD player:  
See page 138.  
No further data can be recorded on finalized  
disc.  
Do not insert a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R recorded  
on a DVD recorder manufactured by a company other  
than Hitachi, and not finalized, in this DVD video  
camera/recorder: Doing so will make the disc  
unusable.  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R discs recorded on this  
DVD video camera/recorder or other 8 cm DVD-RW  
(VF-mode)/DVD-R discs can be played back on other  
DVD players or other devices conforming to 8 cm  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R, but playback on all DVD  
players is not guaranteed.  
Note:  
Use this DVD video camera/recorder to finalize the  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc recorded on the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
2
Insert the disc into the DVD player and play  
it back.  
Playback may not be possible on some DVD players,  
or it may depend on the recorded status of DVD-RW  
(VF-mode)/DVD-R discs: In such cases, play back the  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc on this DVD video  
camera/recorder. Also, playback on DVD players may  
stop momentarily between scenes.  
See the instruction manual for DVD player.  
82  
13  
Recording (Dubbing) Images  
Before connecting this DVD video camera/recorder to another device,  
be sure to turn both devices off.  
1
2
Insert a recordable disc* or card* into this DVD video camera/recorder  
(see pages 25, 28).  
Before You Begin  
*1 No photo can be recorded on DVD-RW/DVD-R.  
*
2 Only photos can be recorded: No video can be recorded.  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES FROM OTHER VIDEO DEVICE  
You can record (dub) images from other video devices to disc or card in this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
Use the AV/S input/output cable (provided) to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to the  
other video device as follows:  
Signal flow  
To S-VIDEO  
output jack of  
VCR, etc.*  
To video/audio  
output jacks  
To AV input/output jack  
Red  
AV/S input/output cable  
(provided)  
White  
Yellow  
* If you are using DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA, and the connected AV device has an S-VIDEO output jack, you  
can connect the S-VIDEO jack of AV/S input/output cable.  
1
Set the input source on  
the DVD video camera/  
recorder to “LINE (L  
IN)”.  
L
IN  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
3
Press the REC button.  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
Recording will start on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
Switch the input  
referring to “Input  
Source” on page 97.  
The operation of this line-input recording is  
the same as for recording movie.  
Press the PHOTO button when recording a  
photo.  
Choose “S LINE” to input S-VIDEO signal  
(only for DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA).  
2
Turn on the connected device, and start  
playback.  
The picture will appear on the LCD screen or  
viewfinder of this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
83  
Note:  
If you operate the DVD video camera/recorder  
connected to another device, always power the  
camera/recorder from AC outlet using the AC adapter/  
charger.  
If you use a Hitachi VCR, it will be operated by the  
remote control provided with the DVD video camera/  
recorder. When recording an image from a Hitachi  
VCR, change the remote control code of the VCR to  
other than “VCR2”.  
With DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA, using S-VIDEO  
will enable you to record clearer images.  
The DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A cannot record  
S-VIDEO input.  
Reduce the volume of external input sound heard  
from the built-in speaker: The loud volume may cause  
noise to enter the recorded image.  
The recorded contents can be played back in the  
same manner as when playing back camera images  
recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
The “Input Source” setting will return to “CAMERA”  
whenever DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Recording of most images is prohibited by the copy-  
guard signal to protect the copyright, except for  
images recorded on camcorders for personal  
enjoyment. “COPY PROTECTED” appears in these  
images: They cannot be recorded on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
Typical copyright protected images include those of  
DVD video, LD, recorded video tapes, some parts of  
digital satellite broadcasts, etc.  
If a video signal that cannot be read by this DVD  
video camera/recorder is present – even in images  
recorded on camcorder for personal enjoyment  
without copy-guard signal – the input image may not  
be recorded normally.  
If the input signal is interrupted by switching the  
channel on TV or switching the signal using video  
selector (see “Terminology”, p. 166), normal recording  
cannot be performed.  
84  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES FROM OTHER VIDEO CAMERAS  
1
2
You can record (dub) images from other video cameras on a disc* or card* in DVD video camera/  
recorder. Use the AV/S input/output cable (provided) to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to  
the other video camera.  
1
*
*
No photo can be recorded on DVD-RW/DVD-R.  
Only photos can be recorded: No video can be recorded.  
2
DVD video camera,  
8mm video camera,  
VHS video camera,  
etc.  
*1  
Signal flow  
To S-VIDEO output  
jack of video  
camera, etc.*2  
To AV input/  
output jack  
3 relay adapters  
(generally available)  
AV/S input/output cable (provided)  
*1: The AV/S input/output cable provided with this DVD video camera/recorder can be directly connected to some  
video cameras.  
*2: If the video camera to be connected has an S-VIDEO output jack, you can connect it to the DVD video camera/  
recorder (only for DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA).  
1
Set the input source on  
the DVD video camera/  
recorder to “LINE (L  
IN)”.  
Note:  
L
IN  
With DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA, using S-VIDEO  
will enable you to record clearer images.  
Reduce the volume of external input sound heard  
from the built-in speaker: The loud volume may cause  
noise to enter the recorded image.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
Switch the input  
referring to “Input  
Source” on page 97.  
Still images can also be recorded on DVD-RAM disc  
or card. See “SWITCHING EXTERNAL INPUT  
RECORDING METHOD (PHOTO INPUT)” on  
page 98 for details, and “Recording Stills” on page 52  
for how to record still images.  
Choose “S LINE” to input S-VIDEO signal  
(only for DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA).  
2
3
Turn on the connected device, and start  
playback.  
The picture will appear on the LCD screen or  
viewfinder of this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
Press the REC button.  
Recording will start on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
The operation of this line-input recording is  
the same as for recording movie.  
85  
RECORDING (DUBBING) IMAGES ON OTHER VIDEO DEVICES  
You can record (dub) images played back on this DVD video camera/recorder, on other video  
devices.  
Use the AV/S input/output cable (provided) to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to another  
video device as shown in the following figure:  
Signal flow  
To S-VIDEO  
input jack of  
VCR, etc.*  
To video/audio  
input jacks  
To AV input/output jack  
Red  
AV/S input/output cable  
(provided)  
White  
Yellow  
* If the video device to be connected has an S-VIDEO input jack, you can connect it to the DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select a scene to be played back.  
Note:  
Using an S-VIDEO jack will deliver clearer images.  
Audio is heard from the speaker: If the volume is too  
high, noise may enter the dubbed image.  
It is recommended that you use Disc Navigation to  
create a play list including the scenes to be dubbed  
among the scenes recorded on this DVD video  
camera/recorder (p. 127).  
Set the channel of the connected video device  
to an external input.  
4
Press the playback (A) button on this DVD  
video camera/recorder and the record button  
on connected device: The DVD video  
camera/recorder will start playback and the  
recorded device will record (dub) it.  
Be sure to use the AC adapter/charger to power the  
DVD video camera/recorder from AC outlet, to prevent  
battery power from shutting off during recording on  
another video device.  
If you are using a Hitachi VCR, using the remote  
control provided with this DVD video camera/recorder  
may operate the VCR. To record (dub) images from  
the DVD video camera/recorder to Hitachi VCR,  
change the remote control code of VCR to a position  
other than “VCR2”.  
86  
Advanced Techniques  
This section explains about various settings to further extend the usefulness of this DVD  
video camera/recorder.  
Checking Flow of Normal Menu  
The following two on-screen menu modes are available with this DVD video camera/recorder:  
• Quick Menu: To display only the fundamental menu items for first timers (p. 64)  
• Normal Menu: To display all menu items for experts  
Camera Functions  
Press the MENU button while the camera image is being displayed on the LCD monitor: The Normal  
Menu will appear.  
Use the f/e/d/c buttons to select a menu item, and then press the A button to choose  
the option.  
See page 65 for the setting method.  
The screens used here to explain are displayed when DVD-RAM disc is used. Some items will not  
appear when a DVD-RW/DVD-R disc or card is used, or when no disc is inserted.  
No menu appears during recording.  
<Menu screen for setting>  
Display of selected  
Camer a F u nc t i on s S e t u p  
setup item  
Auto  
Spo r t s  
Po r t r a i t  
Spo t l i gh t  
Sand&Snow  
Low L i gh t  
P r og r a  
h i t e Ba l .  
E I S  
D i g . Zoo  
M IC . F i l t e r  
m
AE  
W
Selection of setup items  
Options settable  
S : Camera Functions Setup  
T : Record Functions Setup  
U : Date Setup  
m
V : LCD/EVF Setup  
W : Initial Setup  
Display of disc or card  
being used (p. 55)  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Guide display  
Functions settable  
87  
Flow of Normal Menu  
Refer to page indicated for details of each function.  
*9  
Camera Functions Setup  
Date Setup  
Ca  
m
e r a Fun c t  
P r og r a  
i
ons Se  
t
t
t
up  
o
o
Da t e Se t up  
m
AE  
:
:
:
:
:
Au  
Au  
On  
W
E
h i t e Ba l .  
I
S
Da  
Da  
t
t
e
e
Se t  
Mod e  
D i g . Zoom  
4 0 x  
O f  
:
M/D / Y  
M IC . F t e r  
i
l
f
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Program AE (p. 89)  
White balance (p. 91)  
EIS (p. 93)  
Date setting (p. 38)  
Display format (p. 39)  
*9  
*1  
Digital zoom (p. 57)  
*2  
*9  
Microphone filter (p. 93)  
LCD/EVF Setup  
*3  
Flash (p. 79)  
LCD/ EVF Se t up  
*1: Not displayed when DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA  
is in “N” or “P” status.  
*2: Displayed only in “O” status.  
Ad  
EVF  
j
us  
D
t
i
*3: Displayed when DZ-GX20MA is recording a photo  
(not displayed when the optional Video Flash is  
connected).  
s p  
l
a y  
:
Au t  
o
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Adjust (p. 101)  
EVF Display (p. 102)  
Record Functions Setup  
Rec o r d F u n c t  
i
o n s Se  
t
up  
Initial Setup  
V I DEO Mode  
1 6 : 9  
:
:
:
:
F
O f  
CAMERA  
On  
I NE  
f
I
npu  
t
S o u r c e  
pu  
OSD Ou  
t
t
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
Se t up  
Beep  
Po er Save  
Re c o r d LED  
L a ng u age  
:
:
:
:
:
O
O f  
On  
Eng  
A u t o  
n
f
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
w
l
i
s
h
De  
m
o
Mode  
*4  
Reset  
Movie quality (p. 94)  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
*5  
16:9 (p. 95)  
Input selection (p. 97)  
*6*9  
*9  
External still input  
(p. 98)  
Beep (p. 103)  
*7  
*9  
Self-timer (p. 99)  
Power save (p. 103)  
Recording LED (p. 104)  
Language selection (p. 104)  
Demo mode (p. 165)  
Reset (p. 105)  
*8*9  
*9  
On-screen information display output  
(p. 100)  
*4: Not displayed with DVD-RAM disc in “N” status.  
The quality mode is displayed in “P” status. (p. 97)  
*5: Not displayed in “N” or “P” status, or with external  
input.  
*6: Displayed with DVD-RAM disc in “N” status, or “P”,  
and input selection is set to external signal or  
S external signal.  
*7: Displayed with DVD-RAM disc in “N” status, or “P”  
status.  
*8: Displayed only when input selection is set to  
camera.  
*9: Not displayed in Quick Menu.  
88  
1<>23  
Setting Up Camera Functions  
See page 65 for how to set.  
No menu screen appears with external input.  
Before You Begin  
SELECTING SHOOTING MODE TO MATCH THE SUBJECT  
(SWITCHING PROGRAM AE MODE)  
This DVD video camera/recorder automatically detects the status of subject and surrounding  
situation and records the optimum image: If you choose the shooting mode to match the recording  
conditions, clearer images will be recorded.  
1
2
Press the MENU button, use the f/e/  
d/c buttons to choose “Program AE” on  
the “Camera Functions Setup” screen, and  
then press the A button.  
MENU  
The options will appear on the right of  
“Program AE”.  
Use the f/e/d/  
Camer a F u nc  
P r og r a  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
c buttons to choose  
the desired option, and  
then press the A  
button: The selected  
option will be set.  
m
AE  
Auto  
Spo r t s  
W
E
h i t e Ba l .  
I
S
Po r  
Spo  
t
t
r
l
a
i
i
t
D i g . Zoo  
m
t e r  
gh t  
M IC . F  
i
l
Sand&Snow  
Low  
Use f / e / d / c to select,  
and then press A to designate.  
L
i
gh t  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
Selected AE mode  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
a Auto : The camera/recorder automatically  
judges the subject and surrounding environment  
for optimum recording.  
s Sports : Reduces blurring when recording  
rapidly moving subjects such as in golf or tennis.  
t Portrait : Makes a subject, such as a person  
or a creature, stand out from a blurred  
background.  
u Spotlight : Prevents overexposure of subject  
portrait face, etc. when strong light strikes the  
subject, as in a wedding or on stage.  
v Sand & Snow : Prevents underexposure of  
subject portrait face, etc. in a place where  
reflection of light is intense, such as at the  
seaside in midsummer or on a ski slope.  
w Low Light : Allows user to record in a dark  
place even with decreased lighting.  
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
2
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
0
6
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
The menu screen will disappear.  
Note:  
You can check the selected AE mode by the on-  
screen information display. However, nothing will  
appear in the Auto mode.  
The shooting mode set as above will be stored in  
memory even if the DVD video camera/recorder is  
turned off.  
When recording in a dark area, an after-image will  
appear when filming a moving subject or if camera  
shake occurs (it is therefore recommended that you  
use a tripod in such cases).  
Turn the LCD monitor 180º during recording:  
The LCD monitor light can then be used for  
recording.  
If the Sports mode is used under a fluorescent light,  
the image may flicker: In this case, use the Auto mode  
for recording.  
89  
RECORDING DARK SUBJECTS USING LCD MONITOR LIGHT  
When Program AE is set to Low Light, you can use the light from LCD monitor to record a subject.  
1
2
Press the MENU button, and choose  
“Program AE” from the “Camera Functions  
Setup” menu.  
Note:  
Use the viewfinder to check the image to be recorded.  
The LCD monitor light allows you to record a subject  
up to 3.2 feet (1 m) even in a dark place.  
An after-image will appear when filming a moving  
subject or if camera shake occurs (it is recommended  
that you use a tripod).  
Choose “Low Light”,  
Camer a F u nc  
P r og r a  
h i t e Ba l .  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
and designate it.  
m
AE  
Auto  
Spo r t s  
W
If a subject cannot be focused properly, manually  
adjust the focus (see page 75).  
E I S  
D i g . Zoo  
M IC . F  
Po r  
Spo  
Sand&Snow  
t
t
r
l
a
i
i
t
m
t e r  
gh t  
i
l
Low  
L
i
gh t  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
3
4
Press the MENU  
button to end the  
setting.  
REM  
3
9
4
8
0
:
0
0
AM  
9
/
3
/
2
0
0
6
Open the LCD  
monitor, turn it  
180º so that it faces  
the same direction  
as the lens: The  
LCD monitor will  
light white.  
90  
ADJUSTING COLOR (WHITE BALANCE)  
This DVD video camera/recorder automatically adjusts the color of subject. Change the white  
balance setting depending on the recording conditions.  
Mode  
Setting content  
On-screen display  
Auto  
Set  
White balance always automatically adjusted  
None  
You can manually adjust white balance to match the light  
source or situation (p. 92)  
h
i
Outdoor  
Indoor 1  
To record in fine weather  
To record under incandescent light, halogen light or bulb-  
color type fluorescent light  
j
k
Indoor 2  
To record under fluorescent light  
1
Press the MENU  
button, choose “White  
Bal.” on the “Camera  
Functions Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
Note:  
Camer a F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
AE  
h i t e Ba l .  
The white balance mode can be confirmed using the  
on-screen information.  
P r og r a  
m
W
E
D i  
Au t  
Set  
o
I
S
g
The white balance setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
Do not block the infrared sensor (see “Terminology”,  
p. 166) with hand, etc.  
.
Zoo  
m
t e r  
Ou t do o r  
I ndoor  
I ndoor  
M IC .  
F
i
l
1
2
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
2
Choose the desired  
option, and then press  
the A button.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
White balance mode  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
Infrared sensor block  
3
If a tele or wide-conversion lens is used, the auto  
white balance may not operate depending on the  
recording conditions. If this happens, set to the mode  
to match the recording conditions, or manually set the  
white balance.  
Be sure to remove the lens cap before turning the  
DVD video camera/recorder on: If the DVD video  
camera/recorder is turned on with the lens capped,  
the white balance will not work normally.  
91  
Setting white balance manually  
1
Point the DVD  
video camera/  
recorder at a white  
object so that it fills  
the screen. Use an  
object that is not  
transparent.  
If focus is not  
correct when the  
white object fills the screen, manually focus  
the object, referring to “Manually Focusing  
Subject” (see page 75).  
Note:  
Thick paper  
The white balance set using the “Set” option will be  
stored in memory until it is re-set.  
Do not use a colored object when setting the white  
balance: The appropriate tint cannot be set.  
If “Input Source: LINE, S-LINE” has been specified,  
you cannot use the “Set” mode of white balance  
(p. 97).  
The setting on white balance “Set” may not be  
possible in a dark place. Also, the white balance  
cannot be set when the zoom bar is in the digital  
zoom range (p. 57). In such status, the “h” indicator  
will remain blinking. Set the white balance in a bright  
place with “Dig. Zoom: Off” specified.  
If the recording conditions have changed, re-set the  
white balance for appropriate colors.  
2
3
Press the MENU  
Camer a F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
AE  
h i t e Ba l .  
button, choose “White  
Bal.”, “Set”, and then  
press the A button.  
The setting will be stored in memory even when the  
DVD video camera/recorder is turned off: The “h”  
indicator will blink when the DVD video camera/  
recorder is turned on next time. Re-set the white  
balance as needed.  
P r og r a  
m
W
E
D i  
Au t  
Set  
o
I
S
g
.
Zoo  
m
t e r  
Ou t do o r  
I ndoor  
I ndoor  
M IC .  
F
i
l
1
2
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
Hold A pressed until  
the “h” indicator  
changes from blinking  
to a steady light. When  
the “h” indicator  
lights, the white balance  
setting will be  
Se t  
EX I T  
RAM  
complete.  
4
Press the C button to  
end the setting.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
92  
USING THE ELECTRONIC IMAGE STABILIZER (EIS)  
When you use zoom (see page 57) to record a magnified subject image, it will correct fuzziness in the  
recorded image.  
1
Press the MENU  
After recording with EIS set to “Off”, it is  
recommended that you return the setting to  
“On” and then turn the DVD video camera/  
recorder off, unless you normally record with  
“Off” setting.  
Ca  
m
e r a F u nc  
t
i
on s Se t u p  
AE  
h i t e Ba l .  
button, choose “EIS” on  
the “Camera Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
P r og r a  
m
W
E
D i  
I
S
g
On  
Of  
.
Z
F
o om  
t e r  
f
M IC .  
i
l
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Note:  
The EIS setting will be stored in memory even when  
the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
It is recommended that you specify “EIS: Off” when  
using the DVD video camera/recorder on a desk or  
tripod.  
2
3
Choose the “On” or “Off”, and then press the  
A button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
When “EIS: On” is specified, there will be a slight  
difference between the actual movement and the  
movement on screen.  
Gross camera shake may not be entirely corrected  
even if “EIS: On” is specified: Firmly hold the DVD  
video camera/recorder with both hands.  
EIS may not operate correctly when the tele or wide-  
conversion lens is used.  
Checking EIS On or Off  
You can check EIS On or Off by the on-screen  
information display.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
EIS  
EIS cannot be used when recording photos on DZ-  
GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA.  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
RECORDING SUBJECT USING LARGE MAGNIFICATION (DIGITAL ZOOM)  
See page 57 for setting on digital zoom.  
REDUCING WIND NOISE DURING RECORDING (MIC.FILTER)  
When recording sound from the microphone built into this DVD video camera/recorder, you can  
reduce wind noise in recording.  
If “MIC.Filter: On” is specified, the low-frequency components in the sound picked up by  
microphone will be cut off during recording: This makes it easier to hear the target voice or sound  
during playback.  
1
2
Press the MENU  
button, choose  
“MIC.Filter” on the  
“Camera Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
3
Press the MENU button  
to end the setting.  
Camer a F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
AE  
h i t e Ba l .  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
P r og r a  
m
REM3  
0
MIN  
W
E
I
S
D i g . Zoo  
m
t e r  
M IC . F  
i
l
O
O
n
f
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
f
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
Note:  
You can also use the on-  
screen display to confirm  
that the MIC.Filter has been  
set.  
Microphone filter icon  
Choose the desired option, and then press the  
A button.  
The MIC.Filter setting will be stored in memory even  
when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
The MIC.Filter function will work only during movie  
recording.  
The microphone filter function works only with the  
built-in microphone: It will not function when using an  
external microphone (p. 78).  
93  
Setting Up Record Functions  
1<>2  
SWITCHING MOVIE QUALITY (VIDEO MODE)  
Choose the movie quality from “XTRA”, “FINE”, “STD”.  
It is recommended that you record critical subjects in the “XTRA” or “FINE” mode. (p. 29)  
1
Press the MENU  
Note:  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
The movie quality setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“VIDEO Mode” on the  
“Record Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
V
I
DEO Mode  
XTRA  
F I NE  
STD  
1 6 : 9  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
OSD  
O
u t pu t  
The “VIDEO Mode” setting will not change even if the  
disc is replaced.  
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
When using DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc, you  
cannot switch the setting on movie quality or wide-  
screen mode while recording on the disc: The DVD  
video camera/recorder will be automatically set to the  
movie quality or wide-screen mode first used with the  
disc for recording.  
The movie quality setting is effective only during  
movie recording: The setting will not be displayed  
during recording of stills.  
and then press the A button.  
2
3
Choose the desired quality mode, and then  
press the A button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
Movie quality  
Block-like noise may appear in recorded image, or the outline of subject image is distorted under the  
recording conditions listed below: Pan the DVD video camera/recorder as slowly as possible. (Block  
noise is likely to appear in the “STD” mode):  
If there is a complicated pattern in background (as in following figure on left)  
If the DVD video camera/recorder is moved excessively or quickly  
If subject is moving rapidly even when the DVD video camera/recorder is not moving  
(Image when block-like noise occurs)  
(Image without block-like noise)  
94  
1<>2  
SETTING TO WIDE TV SCREEN MODE (16:9 MODE)  
When viewing recorded images later on a wide-screen TV (aspect ratio 16:9), specify wide-screen  
(16:9) mode “On”: You can also record images with the aspect ratio changed (the aspect ratio with  
“Off” is 4:3).  
“16:9 On” specified  
(aspect ratio 16:9)  
“16:9 Off” specified  
(aspect ratio 4:3)  
1
Press the MENU button, choose “16:9” on the  
“Record Functions Setup” menu screen, and  
then press the A button.  
2
3
Choose “On”, and then press the A button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
0
:
0
0
0
: 0  
0
REM3  
MIN  
V
1
I
6
DEO Mode  
:
9
On  
Of  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
OSD Ou t p u t  
f
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
0
FINE  
9
/
3
2
6
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
16:9 mode icon  
When viewing playback on an ordinary TV screen later, specify “16:9 Off”: Recording with “16:9 On”  
specified will be played back on an ordinary TV with longer vertical direction of image.  
An image recorded with “16:9 On” specified will appear as follows:  
Display on LCD monitor screen  
Display in viewfinder  
95  
Note:  
The 16:9 setting will be kept even after the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
The 16:9 mode cannot be used with photo recording, external input, S-VIDEO external input (for DZ-GX20MA or  
DZ-MV780MA only), or “STD” recording using DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc.  
Once the DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc has been recorded in the wide-screen mode, you will not be able to  
switch to recording of external input or S-VIDEO external input (DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only) using the  
same disc.  
When using DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R, switching between wide mode (16:9) and normal mode (4:3) will not be  
possible while using the same disc.  
Images recorded with “16:9 On” (aspect ratio 16:9) specified will be played back with the setting used during  
recording regardless of the 16:9 setting then being used.  
The characters of dates and titles will be longer in the vertical direction on a wide-screen TV and on the LCD  
monitor of this DVD video camera/recorder.  
When “16:9 On” is specified, black bands will appear across the top and bottom of LCD monitor screen (except on  
menu or Disc Navigation screen, or playback image recorded with “16:9 Off” is specified).  
The 16:9 setting is not compatible with ID-1/ID-2*.  
To view images recorded at 16:9 setting, switch the aspect ratio of your TV: See TV instruction manual for this  
switching.  
When using a video selector (see “Terminology”, p. 166), the TV may not automatically be switched to 16:9 mode.  
* This system records the aspect ratio (16:9, 4:3) information in void space between video signals.  
96  
3
SWITCHING QUALITY OF STILL IMAGE (QUALITY)  
You can switch the still recording quality only when using card.  
It is recommended that you use “FINE” when recording vital images. (p. 31 “SIZE AND  
QUALITY OF PHOTOS”)  
1
2
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU  
button to end the  
setting.  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Quality” on the  
“Record Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
REM  
9
9
9
Qu a  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
Se T i e r  
u t pu t  
l
i
t
y
F I NE  
NO  
R
O
M
l
f
m
EC  
OSD  
O
8
0
:
0
0
AM  
NORM  
9
/
3
/
2
0
0
6
ENTER  
RETURN  
Still recording quality  
and then press the A button.  
Note:  
The still quality setting will be stored in memory even  
when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Choose the option you want, and then press  
the A button.  
1<>23  
RECEIVING IMAGE FROM ANOTHER DEVICE (INPUT SOURCE)  
If you wish to input an image from another device to this DVD video camera/recorder, you must  
first switch the setting on the DVD video camera/recorder.  
Refer to the explanation starting from page 83 on how to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to  
other devices or record images input from them.  
Setting  
CAMERA  
LINE  
Content  
Usually select this option.  
On-screen display  
No display  
To input image from another device  
L IN  
*
S LINE  
To input S-VIDEO signal from another device  
S IN  
* Displayed on DZ-GX20MA or DZ-MV780MA only.  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button  
to end the setting.  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
L
IN  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Input Source” on the  
“Record Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
and then press the A button.  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
V
I
DEO Mode  
1 6  
:
9
CAMERA  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
OSD Ou t p u t  
L
I
NE  
L I NE  
Note:  
S
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
The “Input Source” setting will  
return to “CAMERA” whenever  
the DVD video camera/  
recorder is turned off.  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
External input icon  
2
Choose “LINE”, and then press the A  
button.  
97  
13  
SWITCHING EXTERNAL INPUT RECORDING METHOD (PHOTO INPUT)  
When “Input Source: LINE or S LINE” is specified, you can record stills of externally input images  
on either a DVD-RAM disc or a card. The DVD video camera/recorder can record an external image  
with little movement by specifying “Frame”, but “Field” is recommended for recording image with  
movement.  
On-screen display  
Recording  
Details of setting  
format  
DVD-RAM  
card  
Does not suit recording of frequently moving video  
subjects, despite high image quality. Frame suits recording  
of less moving video.  
Frame  
Field  
D
G
Suitable for recording of frequently moving video subjects.  
C
F
1
Press the MENU  
Note:  
Re c o r d F u nc  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
PHOTO I n p u t  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
The PHOTO Input setting can be confirmed using the  
on-screen information.  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“PHOTO Input” on the  
“Record Functions  
Setup” menu screen,  
F r ame  
Se  
l
f
T i mer  
F
i
e
l
d
The PHOTO Input setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
Refer to “Recording (Dubbing) Images”, p. 83 to see  
how to connect the DVD video camera/recorder to  
another device.  
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
and then press the A button.  
2
3
Select the desired option and then press the  
A button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
L
IN  
REM  
Still external input icon  
(Field)  
9
9
9
8
0
:
/
0
0
AM  
9
/
3
2
0
0
6
98  
13  
SELF-TIMER  
You can record photos using the self-timer function, as with ordinary cameras.  
The self-timer function is valid only when recording photos (stills).  
1
Press the MENU  
4
Press the PHOTO button.  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose “Self  
Timer” on the “Record  
Functions Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
I n p u t Sou r ce  
Se T i mer  
OSD Ou t p u t  
The recording indicator at the front of DVD  
video camera/recorder will blink.  
The self-timer indicator will start to count  
down, and recording will commence  
approximately 10 seconds later.  
l
f
On  
Of  
f
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Note:  
You can also check that self-timer has been set by  
reviewing the on-screen information.  
2
3
Select “On”, and then press the A button.  
The self-timer will be set.  
To release the self-timer mode, choose “Off” on the  
menu screen or turn DVD video camera/recorder off.  
To suspend self-timer, press the PHOTO button again  
before recording starts, or press the C button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
1
0
REM  
9
9
9
Self-timer recording  
8
0
:
0
0
AM  
9
/
3
/
2
0
0
6
99  
1<>23  
SETTING ON-SCREEN DISPLAY OUTPUT ON OR OFF (OSD OUTPUT)  
If you connect this DVD video camera/recorder to a TV to view images on TV screen, you can  
switch off the on-screen information (displayed in the viewfinder or on the LCD screen) from the TV  
screen.  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
Re c o r d F u nc  
t
i
on s S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose “OSD  
Output” on the “Record  
Functions Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
V
1
I
6
DEO Mode  
Note:  
:
9
I n p u t Sou r ce  
OSD Ou t p u t  
The “OSD Output” setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
On  
Of  
f
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Even if “Off” is chosen, the on-screen information will  
appear during playback. See page 63 for playback on-  
screen information display.  
Even after the on-screen information is removed from  
the TV screen, it will still appear in the viewfinder or  
on the LCD screen.  
The on-screen display output functions only when the  
input selection is set to camera: It cannot be set  
during external input.  
2
Choose “On” or “Off”, and press the A  
button.  
LCD screen or viewfinder  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
“On” setting  
“Off” setting  
0
:
0
0
:
0
0
REM3  
0
MIN  
8
0
:
/
0
0
0
AM  
FINE  
9
/
3
2
0
6
TV screen  
TV screen  
100  
1<>23  
LCD/EVF Setup  
SETTING BRIGHTNESS OF LCD SCREEN (LCD BRIGHTNESS)  
1
Press the MENU  
LCD/ EVF Se t up  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
Ad  
EVF  
j
u s  
D
t
i
s p l a y  
“Adjust” on the “LCD/  
EVF Setup” menu  
screen, and then choose  
“LCD Brightness”.  
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Use f / e / d / c to select,  
and then press A to designate.  
The brightness adjustment bar will appear on  
the screen.  
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
2
Use the d/c buttons  
LCD/ EVF Ad j u s t  
for adjustment.  
LCD Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
Note:  
EVF Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
The brightness setting will be stored in memory even  
after the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Press d :  
The screen becomes  
dimmer.  
Co  
l
o r L ev e  
ADJUST  
l
ENTER  
RAM  
Press c :  
The screen becomes  
brighter.  
Brightness  
adjustment bar  
SETTING BRIGHTNESS OF VIEWFINDER (EVF BRIGHTNESS)  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button to end the  
adjustment.  
LCD/ EVF Se t up  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Adjust” on the “LCD/  
EVF Setup” menu  
screen, and then choose  
“EVF Brightness”.  
Ad  
EVF  
j
u s  
D
t
i
Note:  
s p l a y  
The brightness setting is stored in memory even after  
the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
2
Use the d/c buttons  
for adjustment.  
LCD/ EVF Ad j u s t  
LCD Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
EVF Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
Press d :  
The screen becomes  
dimmer.  
Co  
l
o r L ev e  
ADJUST  
l
ENTER  
RAM  
Press c :  
The screen becomes  
brighter.  
Brightness  
adjustment bar  
101  
SETTING COLOR DENSITY (COLOR LEVEL)  
You can adjust the color density of the LCD monitor screen and viewfinder.  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button.  
LCD/ EVF Se t up  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Adjust” on the “LCD/  
EVF Setup” menu  
screen, and then choose  
“Color Level”.  
Note:  
Ad  
EVF  
j
u s  
D
t
i
The color setting will be stored in memory even after  
the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Even if the brightness or density of LCD monitor  
screen or viewfinder is changed, the brightness or  
density of the recorded image itself will not change.  
s p l a y  
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
The color density adjustment bar will appear  
on the screen.  
2
Use the d/c buttons  
LCD/ EVF Ad j u s t  
for adjustment.  
LCD Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
EVF Br  
i
gh t n e s s  
Press d :  
For lighter color.  
Press c :  
Co  
l
o r L ev e  
ADJUST  
l
ENTER  
RAM  
For denser color.  
Color density  
adjustment bar  
ALWAYS DISPLAYING IMAGE IN VIEWFINDER  
1
Press the MENU  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose “EVF  
Display” on the “LCD/  
EVF Setup” menu  
screen.  
Note:  
LCD/ EVF Se t up  
The setting on EVF Display will be stored in memory  
even after the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Ad  
EVF  
j
u s  
D
t
i
s p l a y  
Au t  
o
O
n
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
2
3
Choose “On” and decide it.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting:  
Images will always appear in the viewfinder  
regardless of whether the LCD monitor is  
open/closed.  
102  
1<>23  
Initial Settings  
SWITCHING OPERATING SOUND ON OR OFF (BEEP)  
Setting  
On  
Content  
Beep is heard when the power switch is changed over, the REC button is  
pressed, etc.  
Off  
No beep is heard.  
1
Press the MENU  
2
3
Select “On” or “Off”, and then press the A  
button.  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Beep” on the “Initial  
Setup” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Be  
Po w e r  
R e c o r d LED  
L a n g u a g e  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
p
On  
Of  
S
a v e  
f
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
Note:  
The “Beep” setting will be stored in memory even when  
the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
TURNING DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER OFF AUTOMATICALLY  
(POWER SAVE)  
Setting  
On  
Content  
To engage power save. If the DVD video camera/recorder is left in the recording  
pause status without being operated for 5 minutes, it will automatically turn off to  
prevent the battery from discharging needlessly.  
Off  
To cancel power save.  
1
Press the MENU  
Note:  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
S e t u p  
To turn the DVD video camera/recorder on again from  
automatic off activated by the power save function,  
set the power switch to “OFF”, and then set it to “O”,  
N” or “P”  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Power Save” on the  
“Initial Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
Be  
Po w e r  
R e c o r d LED  
L a n g u a g e  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
p
S
a v e  
On  
Of  
f
The Power Save setting will not appear in the on-  
screen information display.  
The Power Save setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
2
3
Select “On” or “Off”, and then press the A  
button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
103  
TURNING RECORD LED ON OR OFF (RECORD LED)  
You can switch off the recording indicator on the front of DVD video camera/recorder even during  
recording.  
Setting  
On  
Content  
The recording indicator will light red to show that the DVD video camera/recorder  
is recording.  
Off  
The recording indicator will not light even during recording.  
2
3
Select “On” or “Off”, and then press the A  
button.  
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
Recording indicator  
Note:  
The Record LED setting will not appear in the on-  
screen information display.  
The Record LED setting will be stored in memory  
even when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off.  
Specify “Record LED: Off” when recording a subject  
behind a glass or water tank that reflects light: The  
reflected light of the recording indicator will not be  
recorded.  
Even if “Record LED: Off” is specified, the recording  
indicator will light while the self-timer is counting  
down.  
1
Press the MENU  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Record LED” on the  
“Initial Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
Be  
Po w e r  
R e c o r d LED  
L a n g u a g e  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
p
S
a v e  
On  
Of  
f
RAM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
CHANGING DISPLAY LANGUAGE (LANGUAGE)  
You can change the language used to display the menu and information.  
The following shows that English is changed to French.  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
Se  
p
t
up  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Language” on the  
“Initial Setup” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
Be  
Po w e r  
R e c o r d LED  
L an gu age  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
S
a v e  
Eng l i sh  
F r ança  
Español  
Note:  
i
s
The language setting will be stored in memory even  
when the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off.  
Deu  
t
l
sh  
ano  
RAM  
I
t
a
i
ENTER  
RETURN  
2
Select “Français”, and  
then press the A  
button.  
Con  
f
i
g u r  
Be  
Po w e r  
a
t
i
on  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
e
p
S
a v e  
LED E n r g.  
L an gu e  
F r ança  
i
s
Mode Démo  
Régl Défaut  
RAM  
ENTRER  
RETOUR  
104  
RESETTING MENU SETTINGS TO DEFAULTS (RESET)  
You can restore menu settings to defaults (initial settings at the factory (p. 185)). (Note, however, that  
the date/time will not be reset.)  
1
Press the MENU  
3
Press the MENU button to end the setting.  
I
n
i
t
i
a
l
e
S e t u p  
button, use the f/  
e/d/c/A  
buttons to choose  
“Reset” on the “Initial  
Setup” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Be  
Po w e r  
R e c o r d LED  
L a n g u a g e  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
p
S
a v e  
Note:  
To cancel resetting midway, choose “NO” on the screen  
for verification in step 2 or press the C button.  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
The screen for verifying reset will appear.  
If you are sure that you  
2
Re s e t  
wish to reset, use the  
d button to choose  
Re s e t  
?
“YES”, and then press  
YES  
NO  
the A button.  
ENTER  
RAM  
The setting items have  
now been reset to defaults.  
105  
Disc Navigation  
1<>23  
Using Disc Navigation  
STARTING OR TERMINATING DISC NAVIGATION  
Disc Navigation is a tool for editing scenes recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Here is an explanation on “scene” and “program”, so that you will be able to make most use of Disc  
Navigation function.  
The screens in this instruction manual are basically those that will appear when DVD-RAM disc is  
used: Some items will not appear when DVD-RW/DVD-R disc or card is used, but the operation is  
the same.  
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder on (p. 45).  
When using disc: Set the power switch to “O” or “N”.  
When using card: Set the power switch to “P”.  
Before You Begin  
1
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
The Disc Navigation screen (shown on  
page 107) will appear.  
DISC  
NAVIGATION  
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button again.  
Disc Navigation will be terminated and the  
DVD video camera/recorder will enter the  
recording pause status.  
You can also press the C button to end Disc  
Navigation.  
106  
Disc Navigation screen  
Thumbnail (see “Terminology”, p. 166)  
Selected scene number*1  
Number of all scenes  
/
Al l Pr og r a  
ms  
001 / 014  
Cursor  
Current page position*4  
Bar graph  
Still image icon*2  
Operation guide*3  
Disc type icon*5  
PLAY  
RAM  
*1 Scene number refers to display number on thumbnail display screen.  
*2 No still icon will appear for card.  
*3 The operation guide will vary depending on the operation status of DVD video camera/recorder.  
*4 Appears when 13 scenes or more have been recorded.  
*5 “ ” will appear for card.  
Icons to be displayed on thumbnail:  
V .................... Photo (p. 52)  
................. Skip (p. 118)  
[ ...................... Fade-in (p. 117)  
] ...................... Fade-out (p. 117)  
T ..................... Lock (p. 121)  
Note:  
The background color of screen allows you to identify  
whether disc or card is used on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
- Purple: When disc is used.  
- Green: When card is used.  
Pressing the DISPLAY button will display the  
recording date/time of the scene on which the cursor  
is placed in the space for operating guide. Pressing  
DISPLAY again will display the operating guide.  
If no disc or card is inserted, the Disc navigation  
screen cannot be displayed even by pressing the  
DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Each time Disc Navigation is started with a DVD-RW  
(VF-mode)/DVD-R disc inserted, message “Creating  
Thumbnail ...will appear. After the message appears,  
the Disc Navigation screen will appear.  
If the following disc or card is inserted, the Disc  
Navigation screen will appear or some message will  
be displayed:  
- Write-protected disc  
- Finalized DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc  
- DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R recorded on a Hitachi  
DVD video camera/recorder model older than DZ-  
GX20MA/MV780MA/MV750MA/BX31A/GX20A/  
MV780A/MV730A  
- Locked card  
Do not leave the disc navigation screen displayed on  
TV to which the DVD video camera/recorder is  
connected: Doing so could damage the TV screen,  
possibly by burning.  
107  
PLAYING BACK FROM DISC NAVIGATION SCREEN  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
3
Press the A button.  
Use the f/e/d/c buttons to select  
the desired scene.  
Playback will start from the selected scene.  
Note:  
Pressing the d or c button will move the cursor  
to the preceding or following scene.  
Pressing the f or e button will move to  
preceding or following page.  
The selected scene will be framed: This is  
called a “cursor”.  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
001 / 014  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
007 / 014  
Up  
Left  
Right  
PLAY  
RA  
M
PLAY  
RAM  
Down  
A
When playback ends:  
The DVD video camera/  
recorder will enter the  
playback pause status at  
the last image of last scene.  
Pressing the C or DISC  
NAVIGATION button will  
restore the Disc  
Navigation screen.  
When the playback pause  
status continues for as long as 5 minutes, the  
Disc Navigation screen will automatically be  
restored.  
Note:  
Press the A button to temporarily stop playback.  
Pressing A again will start from that point.  
If you press the A button after playback of the last  
scene on disc finishes, playback will start again from  
the beginning of disc.  
Pressing the C button will always restore the Disc  
Navigation screen.  
When playing back photos on card, “Playback” will  
appear. In the case of a photo with a large number of  
pixels, it will take some time for the photo to appear.  
Playback pause  
Playing back photos  
A photo on DVD-RAM disc will be displayed  
for approx. 3 seconds. When playing back  
photos on card, playback will stop after each  
photo playback.  
108  
SELECTING MULTIPLE SCENES  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to randomly select  
multiple scenes.  
Use the f/e/d/c buttons to select  
the desired scene.  
3
Press the SELECT button once:  
The selected scene will be framed in red and  
yellow.  
SELECTING CONSECUTIVE SCENES TOGETHER  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Note:  
You can know the status of scenes from the colors of  
cursor and bargraph:  
Use the f/e/d/  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
005 / 014  
c buttons to point the  
cursor at the first scene  
in the range of scenes  
you want to select.  
Cursor Bar graph  
Status of scenes  
Yellow Light blue Current cursor position  
PLAY  
RAM  
Range of scenes being  
selected  
Blue  
Red  
Light blue  
Red  
Yellow frame  
Scenes already selected  
Pressing the A button after selecting scenes will  
play back only the selected scenes from the  
beginning of each.  
To cancel a selected scene, select the scene to be  
canceled, and then press the SELECT button.  
To cancel all selected scenes, press the C button.  
You can also select scenes in reverse from the last  
scene in the range.  
To release multiple selection, press the C or SELECT  
button before pressing the A button in step 4.  
Up to 999 scenes can be selected for both disc and  
card.  
3
4
Hold down the  
SELECT button for at  
least one second:  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
005 / 014  
The selected scene will  
be doubly framed in  
yellow and blue.  
ENTER  
CANCEL  
RAM  
Double frames in  
yellow and blue  
Use the f/e/d/  
c buttons to select the  
last scene in the range  
you want, and then  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
010/ 014  
press the A button:  
PLAY  
DESELECT ALL  
RAM  
The thumbnails of  
Red frame  
scenes in the specified  
range will be framed in  
red, and then selected.  
When scenes up to  
this point are selected  
109  
FUNCTIONS AVAILABLE WITH DISC NAVIGATION  
The Disc Navigation mode will allow a variety of further operations.  
Functions Available with Disc Navigation  
Reference  
page  
Available function  
Contents  
Editing of scenes  
You can delete unnecessary scenes,  
combine scenes, or divide one scene.  
113 – 116  
117 – 119  
120  
*
E
● ●  
● ●  
Setting special effects to  
scenes  
You can attach fade and skip to a  
scene, and change existing thumbnails.  
Copy from disc to card  
You can copy photos recorded on DVD-  
RAM disc to card.  
Scene lock  
You can lock any scene so that it will  
not be deleted by mistake: Essential  
scenes are thereby protected, and  
recording another still is possible.  
121  
Scene information  
display  
You can display information on one  
scene or multiple scenes, such as  
image quality, recording time, etc.  
123  
● ● ● ● ●  
Changing title  
You can change the title of play list or  
program.  
125, 133  
127  
● ●  
● ●  
Creation of play list  
You can create an original movie by  
changing the combination of scenes.  
Disc or Card  
initialization  
You can initialize a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW  
disc or card so that it can be used on  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
135  
● ● ●  
Remaining display  
(Capacity)  
The remaining recordable movie time  
or number of recordable stills is  
displayed.  
136  
136  
138  
● ● ● ● ●  
Disc protection  
Disc finalization  
You can protect the DVD-RAM/DVD-  
RW (VR-mode) disc to prevent deletion  
or editing by mistake.  
● ●  
You can use this DVD video camera/  
recorder to finalize any DVD-RW/DVD-  
R disc recorded on it so that the disc  
can be viewed on DVD player, etc.  
● ● ●  
Repeat play  
You can repeatedly play back programs  
and scenes.  
139  
140  
● ● ● ●  
Slide show  
You can play back stills continuously.  
* Only deletion is possible.  
Note:  
Note  
Setting special effects to scenes (fade, skip, thumbnail) are unique to this DVD video camera/recorder. When a disc  
with any effects set on this DVD video camera/recorder is directly played back on a DVD recorder/player or read into  
PC, the set effect results will not be reflected in the playback or reading. To reflect the set effect results, connect  
both devices using the AV/S input/output cable and then perform recording (Dubbing, p. 86).  
110  
UNDERSTANDING FLOW OF DISC NAVIGATION MENU  
Press the MENU button on the Disc Navigation screen: The menu screens for Disc Navigation and  
menu screens for disc and card will appear.  
See “Checking Flow of Normal Menu” on page 87.  
Refer to pages indicated for details of settings.  
When using DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
Scene  
Edit  
Effect  
Copy*1 (p. 120)  
Select (p. 122)  
(p. 113)  
(p. 117)  
Divide  
Delete  
Combine  
Move*2  
(p. 115)  
(p. 113)  
(p. 116)  
(p. 116)  
*2 Will appear when a  
play list is displayed.  
Detail  
(p. 123)  
*
1 DVD-RAM only  
Fade  
Skip  
Thumbnail  
(p. 117)  
(p. 118)  
(p. 119)  
Start Current  
Current End  
All  
(p. 122)  
(p. 122)  
(p. 122)  
Play list  
Program  
Switch (p. 128)  
Play (p. 128)  
Create (p. 127)  
Go To  
Disc  
Top  
End  
(p. 134)  
(p. 134)  
Edit  
Title  
(p. 129 – 132)  
(p. 133)  
Finalize Disc*4  
Format Disc  
Protect Disc  
(p. 138)  
(p. 135)  
(p. 136)  
(p. 136)  
(p. 137)  
Delete (p. 133)  
Capacity  
Switch (p. 124)  
Update Control Info.  
Play  
Title  
(p. 125)  
(p. 125)  
*
4 DVD-RW (VR-mode) only  
Others  
Category*3  
Repeat Play  
3 DVD-RAM only  
(p. 139)  
(p. 139)  
All  
VIDEO  
PHOTO  
(p. 139)  
(p. 139)  
(p. 139)  
ETC  
*
On  
Off  
(p. 139)  
(p. 139)  
When using DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc  
Scene  
Select (p. 122)  
Detail (p. 123)  
Start Current (p. 122)  
Current End (p. 122)  
All  
(p. 122)  
Program  
Go To  
Switch (p. 124)  
Disc  
Finalize Disc  
(p. 138)  
Play  
(p. 125)  
Format Disc*5 (p. 135)  
Capacity  
5 DVD-RW (VF-mode) only  
(p. 136)  
*
Top  
End  
(p. 134)  
(p. 134)  
Others  
Repeat Play  
(p. 139)  
On  
Off  
(p. 139)  
(p. 139)  
ETC  
111  
When using card  
Scene  
Delete (p. 113)  
Lock (p. 121)  
Select (p. 122)  
Start Current (p. 122)  
Detail  
(p. 123)  
Current End (p. 122)  
All  
(p. 122)  
Go To  
Card  
Top  
End  
(p. 134)  
(p. 134)  
Slide Show  
Start  
(p. 140)  
Format Card  
Capacity  
(p. 135)  
(p. 136)  
112  
Scene  
1<3  
DELETING SCENES (EDIT – DELETE)  
You may want to delete unwanted scenes.  
Scenes on DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc cannot be deleted, and menu item “Delete” will not  
appear with DVD-R disc.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the scene to be  
7
Press the C button to  
quit.  
De  
l
e
t
e
Sc en e  
0 05 / 0 1 3  
All Programs  
0 05 / 0 1 4  
deleted.  
ENTER  
EX I T  
RAM  
3
Press the MENU  
button.  
PLAY  
DESELECT ALL  
RAM  
Note:  
If you point the cursor at the scene to be deleted on  
DISC NAVIGATION screen, and then press the  
DELETE button on remote control, the screen in step  
5 will appear.  
To delete an unwanted part of a scene on DVD-RAM/  
DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc, divide the scene first, and  
then delete the unnecessary part (see page 115).  
If you delete all data on disc or card, initializing the  
disc or card will be recommended (see page 135).  
If the time of deleted scenes (stills) is quite short, the  
remaining free space of disc may not increase in the  
disc or card remaining indicator.  
Scene to be deleted  
4
Choose “Scene”,  
“Edit”, “Delete”, and  
then press the A  
button.  
When using card,  
choose “Scene”,  
“Delete”, and then  
press the A button.  
Sc ene  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
De v  
De l e t  
Comb  
i
de  
e
ec  
t
i
ne  
l
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
The locked scenes on card cannot be deleted (see  
page 121).  
5
6
The “Delete Scene” screen will appear: If you  
are sure you want to delete the selected scene,  
press the A button.  
If you want to change the scene to be deleted,  
you can change it on this screen.  
The screen for verifying  
De  
l
e
t
e
Sc en e  
/ 30  
Scene No. 005  
deletion will appear:  
Choose “YES”, and then  
press the A button.  
9
/
2006  
8
:
00:00AM  
De  
YES  
l
e
t
e
sc en e?  
NO  
ENTER  
Choose “NO” to cancel  
deletion.  
After Yes or No setting, the “Delete Scene”  
screen will be restored.  
Repeat steps 5 and 6 to delete other scenes.  
113  
Editing using submenu  
Press the MENU button before pressing the A button in step 5 (see page 113): The submenu will  
appear.  
Ed  
i
t
Se  
l
e c  
t
Go To  
De  
E x  
l
i
e t e  
t
S
Cu  
A
t
a
r
l
r
r
t
Cu  
r
r en t  
en t  
End  
To p  
En d  
l
ENTER  
RETURN  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
RA  
M
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Edit  
Delete .......................To delete selected scenes  
Exit............................To restore the Disc Navigation screen  
Select  
Start Current.......To select scenes from the start to the one that the cursor is on  
at the moment  
Current End........To select scenes from the scene the cursor is on to the end  
All .............................To select all scenes  
Top............................To move the cursor to the first scene  
End............................To move the cursor to the last scene  
Go To  
Pressing the C button will restore the screen in step 5.  
Note:  
Although the submenu screen will appear for each setting, some menu items may not appear, depending on the  
setting.  
114  
1<  
DIVIDING MOVIES (EDIT – DIVIDE)  
You can divide a scene into two parts.  
To delete unnecessary portion of scene, first divide the scene, and then delete the unnecessary  
portion.  
1
2
3
4
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the scene to be divided.  
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 5, the submenu will appear (see  
page 114).  
Search and frame advance are useful when  
designating division points.  
Combining scenes that were divided will restore the  
original scene (see page 116).  
If a special effect has been added to the original  
scene, the “IN” effect will be added to the first half of  
scene, and the “OUT” effect, to the latter half.  
The division point may drift before or after the  
designated point by approximately 0.5 seconds.  
Since a scene with a skip set cannot be played back,  
no division point can be specified: Release the skip  
for the scene before dividing it.  
Choose, “Scene”,  
“Edit”, “Divide” and  
Sc ene  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
De v  
De l e t  
Comb  
i
de  
e
ec  
t
then press the A  
button.  
i
ne  
l
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
5
The “Divide Scene”  
screen will appear: If  
you are sure you want to divide the selected  
scene, press the A button: The selected  
scene will be played back.  
If the division point is at a still, a message will appear,  
but no division will be made.  
If the division point is at the start or end of a scene, a  
message will appear, but no division will be made.  
A movie scene whose recording time is 0.5 seconds  
or less cannot be divided.  
If you want to change the scene to be divided,  
you can change it on this screen.  
If free space available on disc is insufficient, division  
will not be possible: Delete unnecessary scenes.  
6
When you reach the  
point where you want  
Se l ect D i v i s i o n Po i n t  
002 RAM 0 : 00 : 18  
to divide the scene,  
press the SELECT  
button.  
SEL  
ENTER  
CANCEL  
The status bar of  
scene being played  
back can be switched  
off or on by pressing  
the DISPLAY button  
7
8
The screen for verifying  
division will appear:  
Choose “YES”, and then  
press the A button.  
D
i
v
i
de Scene  
D
i
v
i
de s cene?  
NO  
YES  
ENTER  
Choose “NO” to cancel  
division.  
After division, the “Divide Scene” screen will  
be restored.  
Repeat steps 5 – 7 to divide another scene.  
Press the C button to quit.  
115  
1<  
COMBINING MULTIPLE SCENES (EDIT – COMBINE)  
If you have recorded numerous short scenes, combining them will be facilitated by the use of Disc  
Navigation.  
Be sure to select consecutive multiple scenes. Combining scenes is possible only when “Category:  
All” is specified (p. 139). Stills cannot be combined.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
6
The screen for verifying  
combination will  
appear: Choose “YES”,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Comb ne Sc e n e s  
i
Select the consecutive multiple scenes to be  
combined.  
Comb  
YES  
i
ne s c e n e s ?  
NO  
ENTER  
See page 109 when selecting multiple scenes.  
Press the MENU button.  
The two images  
3
4
appearing on the verification screen are those  
of the first and last scenes to be combined.  
Choose “NO” to cancel combination.  
After Yes or No setting, the “Combine  
Scenes” screen will be restored.  
The thumbnail of the first scene will appear in  
the combined scene.  
Choose, “Scene”,  
“Edit”, “Combine” and  
Sc ene  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
De v  
De l e t  
Comb  
i
de  
e
ec  
t
then press the A  
button.  
i
ne  
l
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
5
The “Combine Scenes”  
screen will appear: If  
Repeat steps 5 and 6 to combine other scenes.  
you are sure you want to combine the  
selected scenes, press the A button.  
7
Press the C button to quit.  
If you want to change the scenes to be  
combined, you can change them on this  
screen.  
Note:  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 5, the submenu will appear (see  
page 114).  
With fade effect, the “IN” effect of the first video in the  
selected range and the “OUT” effect on the last video  
will be attached to a combined scene.  
Scenes in different programs (different recording  
dates) cannot be combined: Create a play list first,  
and then combine such scenes on the play list.  
1<  
ARRANGING ORDER OF SCENES (EDIT – MOVE)  
You can arrange scenes within a play list by moving them to desired positions. (p. 132) Create a play  
list first, and then arrange the scenes [“CREATING NEW PLAY LIST (CREATE)”, p. 127].  
116  
1<  
DIRECTING SCENES EFFECTIVELY (EFFECT – FADE)  
You can add fading to the beginning and/or end of scene.  
There are three types of special effects:  
Fade Out  
Fade Out  
Fade Out  
Fade In  
Fade In  
Fade In  
White:  
Fades in from white screen  
Fades out to white screen  
Wipe:  
B/W:  
Fades in from black screen  
to vertical direction of screen  
Fades out from vertical  
direction of screen to black  
screen  
Fades in from Black and  
White screen to color screen  
Fades out from color screen  
to Black and White screen  
1
2
3
4
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the scene for adding special effects.  
Press the MENU button.  
If you choose “Enter” and press A, the  
“Fade Set” screen will be restored after a  
message appears.  
Repeat steps 5 and 6 to add fade to other  
scenes.  
Choose, “Scene”,  
“Effect”, “Fade” and  
Sc ene  
7
Press the C button to quit.  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
ec  
t
F ad e  
Sk  
T h umbna  
then press the A  
button.  
i
p
l
i
l
The “[” and/or “]” icon(s) will appear in  
the scenes for which fade in and/or fade out  
have been set.  
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
5
6
The “Fade Set” screen  
will appear: If you are  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
ms  
005 / 013  
sure you want to add the fade effect to the  
scene, press the A button.  
“In” effect  
If you want to change the scene to which fade  
is added, you can change it on this screen.  
PLAY  
RAM  
“Out” effect  
Select the special effects  
for “IN” and/or  
“OUT”, choose “Enter”,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Fa d e  
I N  
None  
OUT  
None  
Note:  
If a disc on which fade has been set on scene with this  
DVD video camera/recorder is played on a DVD  
reorder/player, or the scene is captured into a PC, the  
set fade will not be reflected (see Note on page 110).  
W
h i t e  
h i t e  
W
W
i
i
pe  
pe  
B / W  
W
B / W  
En t e r  
Canc e l  
ENTER  
You can use f/e to  
move the cursor to “IN”, “OUT”, “Enter” or  
“Cancel”.  
Use d/c to choose the effect to be added,  
and then press A to set the effect.  
To cancel setting, choose “Cancel”.  
117  
1<  
PLAYING BACK BY SKIPPING SCENES (EFFECT – SKIP)  
You can specify “Skip” for scenes you do not want to play back: The selected scenes will be skipped.  
1
2
3
4
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the scene to be skipped.  
Press the MENU button.  
6
Press the C button to quit.  
A skip icon “  
” will appear in the  
thumbnail of any scene for which skipping  
has been set.  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
001 / 013  
Choose “Scene”,  
“Effect”, “Skip”, and  
Sc ene  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
Skip icon  
ec  
t
F ad e  
Sk  
T h umbna  
then press the A  
button.  
i
p
l
i
l
a
i
l
PLAY  
RAM  
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
5
The “Set Skip” screen  
will appear: If you are  
Releasing Skip  
sure you want to skip the selected scene,  
Perform the same procedure as setting skip: The  
skip icon will disappear and skipping of the  
scene will be released.  
press the A button.  
If you want to change the scene to be  
skipped, you can change it on this screen.  
After skip setting, the “Set Skip” screen will  
be restored.  
Note:  
Multiple scenes can be selected for skipping (p. 109).  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 5, the submenu screen will appear  
(p. 114).  
Repeat step 5 to set skipping of other scenes.  
If a disc on which skip has been set on scene with  
this DVD video camera/recorder is played on a DVD  
reorder/player, or the scene is captured into a PC, the  
set skip will not be reflected (see Note on page 110).  
118  
1<  
CHANGING IMAGES FOR THUMBNAILS (EFFECT – THUMBNAIL)  
Normally, the first image of the recorded scene is displayed as a thumbnail: You can choose another  
image of the scene for thumbnail. If you set a vivid image to thumbnail, you can know what you  
recorded from a glance at the Disc Navigation screen.  
Original thumbnail  
You can use this image as thumbnail.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
7
8
The screen for verifying  
switching of thumbnail  
will appear: Choose  
“YES”, and then press  
the A button.  
Cha ng e Th u  
m
bna  
i
l
Select the thumbnail of the scene to be  
changed.  
Cha ng e t h u  
YES  
m
bna  
i
l
?
NO  
ENTER  
3
4
Press the MENU button.  
Choose “Scene”,  
Choose “NO” to cancel  
switching of thumbnail.  
After Yes or No setting, the “Change  
Thumbnail” screen will be restored.  
Sc ene  
“Effect”, “Thumbnail”,  
Ed  
E f  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
i
f
t
ec  
t
F ad e  
Sk  
T h umbna  
and then press the A  
button.  
i
p
l
i
l
Repeat steps 5 – 7 to change the other scenes.  
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Press the C button to quit.  
5
6
The “Change  
Se  
l
e c  
t
Thu  
m
b na  
i
l
Po n t  
i
Note:  
Thumbnail” screen will  
appear: If you are sure  
you want to change the  
thumbnail of the  
selected scene, press the  
A button: The  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 5, the submenu screen will appear  
(See page 114).  
A thumbnail of still cannot be changed.  
Since the scene to which skipping is set cannot be  
played back, you will not be able to change its  
thumbnail: Release the skip setting of the scene to  
change the thumbnail.  
If a disc on which thumbnail has been set with this  
DVD video camera/recorder is played on a DVD  
reorder/player, or the scene is captured into a PC, the  
set thumbnail will not be reflected (see Note on  
page 110).  
SEL  
ENTER  
CANCEL  
selected scene will be played back.  
If you want to change the scene whose  
thumbnail is to be changed, you can change it  
on this screen.  
When the image you want to use as the  
thumbnail of the scene appears, press the  
SELECT button.  
119  
13  
COPYING STILLS ON DVD-RAM DISC TO CARD (COPY)  
1
2
3
4
5
Set the power switch to “O” or “N“.  
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the still to be copied.  
Note:  
No movie can be copied.  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 6, the submenu screen will appear  
(p. 114).  
See “Category” (p. 139) to check the stills recorded  
on DVD-RAM disc.  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
Even if all scenes, including movies, are selected to  
be copied, only stills will be copied.  
Data on card cannot be copied to disc.  
The quality of still copied from disc to card will be the  
same as when you recorded still on disc.  
Stills recorded on a device other than this DVD video  
camera/recorder may not be copied normally.  
Press the MENU button.  
Choose “Copy” on the  
“Scene” menu screen,  
Sc ene  
Ed  
i
t
E f f e c t  
Copy  
and then press the A  
button.  
Se  
l
e c t  
De t  
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
6
7
The “Copy to card”  
screen will appear: If  
you are sure you want  
to copy the selected  
still, press the A  
button.  
Copy t o c a r d  
0 0 3 / 0 1 4  
ENTER  
EX I T  
RAM  
If you want to change the still to be copied,  
you can change it on this screen.  
The screen for verifying  
copy will appear:  
Choose “YES”, and then  
Copy t o c a r d  
Copy PHOTO s c e n e s  
t
o
c
a
r
d
?
press the A button.  
YES  
NO  
ENTER  
Choose “NO” to cancel  
copy.  
After Yes or No setting, the “Copy to card”  
screen will be restored.  
Repeat steps 6 and 7 to copy other stills to  
card.  
8
Press the C button to quit.  
120  
3
LOCKING SCENES ON CARD (LOCK)  
You can lock each photo recorded on card so that it will not be deleted or edited by mistake.  
1
2
3
4
5
Set the power switch to “P”.  
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Select the scene to be locked.  
Press the MENU button.  
To unlock the scene:  
Select the locked scene, and then use the same  
procedure as above to unlock the scene: The lock  
icon will disappear and locking will be released.  
Note:  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 6, the submenu screen will appear  
(p. 114).  
Choose “Lock” on the  
“Scene” menu screen,  
Sc ene  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
When initializing the card, the locked scenes will also  
be deleted.  
De  
L o c k  
Se e c t  
De t  
l
e
t
e
and then press the A  
button.  
l
a
i
l
ENTER  
RETURN  
6
The “Lock Set” screen  
will appear: If you are  
sure you want to lock the selected scene,  
press the A button.  
Lock Set  
7 / 19  
Lock icon  
ENTER  
EX I T  
If you want to change the scene to be locked,  
you can change it on this screen.  
After setting, the “Lock Set” screen will be  
restored.  
Repeat step 6 to lock another scene.  
7
Press the C button to quit.  
The lock icon “T” will appear on any scene  
for which lock has been set.  
121  
1<>23  
SELECTING SCENES USING MENU SCREEN (SELECT)  
You can use this “Select” function to select consecutive scenes at one time.  
This function is useful when there are numerous scenes.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
4
5
Choose “Select” on the “Scene” menu screen.  
Point the cursor at the first or last scene to be  
selected: When selecting all scenes, simply  
proceed with step 3.  
Choose “Start →  
Sc ene  
Current”, “Current →  
Ed  
E f  
i
f
t
ec  
t
End” or “All” and then  
Copy  
Se e c t  
De t  
l
S
Cu  
A
t
a
r
l
r
r
t
Cu  
r
r en t  
press the A button.  
a
i
l
en t  
End  
ETC  
3
Press the MENU button.  
l
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
006 / 011  
Current scene  
PLAY  
RAM  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
006 / 011  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
006 / 011  
Al  
l
Pr ogr a  
m
s
006 / 011  
PLAY  
RAM  
PLAY  
RAM  
PLAY  
RAM  
DESELECT ALL  
DESELECT ALL  
DESELECT ALL  
“Start Current” is specified:  
The scenes from the first to  
current will be selected.  
“Current End” is specified:  
The scenes from the current to  
end will be selected.  
“All” is specified:  
All scenes from the first to end  
will be selected.  
Deselecting selected scenes  
Deselecting scenes one by one:  
Deselecting all the selected scenes at once:  
While you are displaying the “All Programs”  
screen on which scenes have been selected, press  
the C button.  
While you are displaying the “All Programs”  
screen on which scenes have been selected,  
choose the scene to be deselected and then press  
the SELECT button.  
Note:  
Up to 999 scenes can be selected.  
122  
1<>23  
DISPLAYING INFORMATION USING MENU SCREEN (DETAIL)  
You can display various information for a scene: the recording mode, recording date/time and  
length, special effects and movie quality mode.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Note:  
If multiple scenes have been selected, the total  
recording time of the selected scenes (total number in  
case of stills) will appear.  
Select the scene whose information you wish  
to know.  
(When using disc)  
3
4
Press the MENU button.  
De t a i  
V I DEO  
( XTRA) :  
( F NE) :  
( STD )  
( -  
PHOTO  
l
:
1m  
0m  
1m  
0m  
1m  
0
i
i
i
i
i
n43sec  
0sec  
n43sec  
(
(
(
(
(
2s c e n e s )  
0s c e n e s )  
2s c e n e s )  
0s c e n e s )  
0s c e n e s )  
Choose “Scene”, “Detail”, and then press the  
A button.  
n
I
*3  
:
:
:
n
n
0sec  
0sec  
-
-
)
*1  
*2  
RETURN  
The detailed information on the scene will  
appear.  
*1 Number of scenes whose quality mode is  
unknown:  
(When using disc)  
This will appear when the disc has a scene  
recorded on a device other than this DVD video  
camera/recorder, only if the disc has a scene  
whose mode is unknown.  
De  
t
a
i
l
Sc e n e N o. 0 0 7  
IDEO (F NE )  
9 / 30 2006  
*2  
*3  
V
I
1m i n13 s e c  
00 00A  
Da t  
S k  
e
p
:
:
/
8
:
:
M
i
O
f
f
*1  
Fa d e IN : None OUT :None  
*2 This will not appear with DVD-RW/DVD-R disc,  
since no still image can be recorded on it.  
*3 Not displayed with a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW/DVD-R  
(finalized) disc that was recorded on another  
device.  
PREV NEXT RETURN  
(When using card)  
*4  
*5  
De  
t
a
i
l
Sc e n e N o.  
1 00–0007 ( 640  
9 / 30 2006  
7
(When using card)  
)
00  
Da t  
e
:
/
8
:
:
00AM  
L o c k  
:
O
f
f
De t a i  
l
Scene No.  
6
PREV  
NEXT  
RETURN  
9
/
27 / 2006 12 : 5 0:00PM  
Scene No.  
7
9
/
30 / 2006  
8
: 0 0:00AM  
*1 Not displayed with DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R  
disc.  
S c e n e s :  
RETURN  
2
*2 Not displayed with DVD-RAM/DVD-RW/DVD-R  
(finalized) recorded on another device.  
*3 Not displayed with a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW/DVD-R  
(finalized) disc that was recorded on another  
device.  
*4 May not appear if the loaded card does not  
comply with DCF.  
*5 Number of pixels on still in horizontal direction:  
This may not appear with a JPEG file that does  
not conform to this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Note:  
DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) is a  
unified image file format for video cameras: Image  
files can be commonly used for all digital devices  
that conform to DCF.  
Pressing the c button will display information on  
the following scene; pressing the d button will  
display information on the preceding scene.  
5
Press the C button to quit.  
123  
Program  
WHAT IS “PROGRAM”?  
Program refers to an assembly of scenes recorded on the same date regardless of whether they are  
movie or still.  
Scene No. 1  
Scene No. 2  
Scene No. 3  
Scene No. 4  
Scene No. 5  
Scene No. 6  
9:00AM  
Movie  
11:45AM Still  
1:30PM  
Movie  
5:20PM  
8:00PM  
Movie  
10:20AM  
Still  
Still  
Program No. 1  
Recorded on September 10  
1<>2  
SWITCHING TO THUMBNAIL DISPLAY OF SPECIFIC DATE (SWITCH)  
Since the scenes recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder are collected as “programs” for each  
recording date, selecting a program will allow you to display only the scenes on a specific date.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
Pressing the C button on the “Switch Program”  
screen will restore the Disc Navigation screen.  
If a disc recorded on another device is loaded in this  
DVD video camera/recorder, the program may not be  
a collection of recordings on the same date.  
Use the f/e/d/  
P r og r am  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Switch” on the  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
P
T
l
i
a y  
t
“Program” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
l
e
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
4
Select the program to  
be displayed, and then  
press the A button.  
Sw  
i
t
c h P r og r a  
m
A
l
l
Pr og r  
a
ms  
0 1  
0 2  
0 3  
8
9
9
/
/
/
3 0 / 2006  
1 0 / 2006  
3 0 / 2006  
The Disc Navigation  
screen of the selected  
program will appear.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
03 9 / 30 / 2006  
001 / 008  
PLAY  
RAM  
124  
1<>2  
PLAYING BACK PROGRAM (PLAY)  
You can play back only the selected program.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
4
Select the program to be played back, and  
then press the A button.  
Playback will start from the first scene of the  
selected program.  
Use the f/e/d/  
c/A buttons to  
P r og r am  
S
t
a
r
t
P r og r a  
m
choose “Play” on the  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
P
T
l
i
a y  
t
“Program” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
l
e
A
l
l
Pr og r  
a
ms  
ETC  
0 1  
0 2  
0 3  
8
9
9
/
/
/
3 0 / 2006  
1 0 / 2006  
3 0 / 2006  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
8
:
00AM  
9 / 30 / 20 06  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Note:  
If “Repeat Play: On” is specified, the selected program  
will be repeatedly played back (PLAYING BACK  
SCENES REPEATEDLY (REPEAT PLAY), p. 139).  
1<  
CHANGING TITLE OF PROGRAM (TITLE)  
The recording date/time has initially been attached to any program.  
You can change the recording date/time to any desired title.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
Use f/e/d/c  
to select a letter, and  
then press the A  
button: The selected  
letter will be entered.  
Title input bar  
T I T L E  
9
/ 3 0 / 2006  
1
2
3
C
P
Ì
4
5
6
F
S
Á
Ä
7
G
T
É
Ë
8
H
U
Í
9
I
V
Ó
Ö
0
J
W
Ú
Ü
SPACE  
A
N
À
Â
B
O
È
Ê
D
Q
Ò
Ô
E
R
Ù
Û
K
X
Ã
Ç
L
Y
Ñ
M
Z
Õ
Choose “Title” on the “Program” menu  
screen, and then press the A button.  
Î
Ï
1
En t e r  
DELETE  
Cancel  
SLECT  
Repeat this procedure  
to create a title.  
Up to 20 characters can  
be input.  
SEL  
INPUT  
4
Select the program  
P r og r a  
m
T
i
t
l
e
Input mode  
whose title you want to  
change, and then press  
the A button.  
0 1  
0 2  
0 3  
8
9
9
/
/
/
3 0 / 2006  
1 0 / 2006  
3 0 / 2006  
Palette for selecting  
characters  
ENTER  
RETURN  
The screen for setting a  
title will appear.  
125  
6
7
After entering the title,  
choose “Enter” and  
then press the A  
button.  
Characters available for entering  
title  
You can use the SELECT button to select  
characters from the “capital letter”, “small  
letter” and “symbol” input modes.  
With step 5, select the input mode and then  
press the A button, or press the DISPLAY  
button.  
T I T L E  
a
t
a
Pa r k  
1
a
n
à
â
2
b
o
è
ê
3
c
p
ì
4
d
q
ò
ô
5
e
r
ù
û
6
f
s
á
ä
7
g
t
é
ë
8
h
u
í
9
i
v
ó
ö
0
j
w
ú
ü
SPACE  
k
x
ã
ç
l
m
z
õ
y
ñ
ß
î
ï
2
En t e r  
Cancel  
SELECT  
SEL  
ENTER  
DELETE  
The screen for verifying  
the change in title will  
appear: Choose “YES”,  
and then press the A  
button.  
T I T L E  
a
n
t
i
a
h
Pa  
r
k
F
i
s
t
i
t
l
e
s
e
t
t
i
n g ?  
T I T L E  
9
/ 3 0 / 2006  
T I T L E  
9
/ 3 0 / 2006  
YES  
NO  
1
a
n
à
â
2
b
o
è
ê
3
c
p
ì
4
d
q
ò
ô
5
e
r
ù
û
6
f
s
á
ä
7
g
t
é
ë
8
h
u
í
9
i
v
ó
ö
0
j
w
ú
ü
SPACE  
1
2
3
C
P
Ì
4
5
6
F
S
Á
Ä
7
G
T
É
Ë
8
H
U
Í
9
I
V
Ó
Ö
0
J
W
Ú
Ü
SPACE  
A
N
À
Â
B
O
È
Ê
D
Q
Ò
Ô
E
R
Ù
Û
K
X
Ã
Ç
L
Y
Ñ
M
Z
Õ
k
x
ã
ç
l
m
z
õ
ENTER  
y
ñ
ß
Î
Ï
î
ï
Choose “NO” to cancel  
changing of the title.  
1
En t e r  
DELETE  
Cancel  
SELECT  
2
En t e r  
DELETE  
Cancel  
SELECT  
SEL  
SEL  
CHANGE  
CHANGE  
After Yes or No setting, the Disc Navigation  
screen of the selected program will appear.  
Input mode  
Note:  
If you wish to delete the letter for title, press the C  
button once: The input letter will be deleted. Holding  
down the C button will delete all letters in the TITLE  
column.  
T I T L E  
9
4
/ 3 0 / 2006  
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
9
0
SPACE  
You can also use the DELETE button on remote  
control to delete any input letters.  
3
En t e r  
DELETE  
Cancel  
SELECT  
SEL  
CHANGE  
Pressing the SELECT button on the title setting  
screen (in step 5) will change the cursor position from  
the title input bar to character select palette, input  
mode number, and then to “Cancel”. You can also use  
f/e/d/c to move the cursor up/down and to  
the left/right and change its position.  
To cancel the setting of title, choose “NO” on the  
screen for verifying the entered title: The screen for  
verifying cancellation of title setting will appear. To  
cancel title setting, choose “YES”.  
If you press the C button on the screen for verifying  
change in title, the title setting screen will be restored.  
Double byte characters set on other devices may be  
displayed blank on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Titles set on this DVD video camera/recorder may not  
be visible on other devices.  
126  
1<  
Play List  
WHAT IS “PLAY LIST”?  
You can create a play list on this DVD video camera/recorder by gathering your favorites from the  
recorded scenes.  
Since the play list is not created by copying data, you will consume little of the disc capacity by  
making a play list. On the other hand, deleting scenes on play list will not increase the remaining  
disc capacity for recording.  
Example:  
Program 1  
Program 2  
Play list 1 created  
Play list of up to No. 99 can be created, and up to 999 scenes can be included in each play list of No. 1  
to No. 99.  
1<  
CREATING NEW PLAY LIST (CREATE)  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
6
When creation of a play list is complete, the  
created play list will appear on the Disc  
Navigation screen.  
Select the scenes to be programmed in a play  
list.  
Note:  
3
4
Press the MENU button.  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
Only the data on scenes is recorded on play list: If  
you create or delete play lists, the original scenes in  
programs will not be erased.  
Use the f/e/d/  
P
l
a y L  
i
s
S
P
t
w
l
c/A buttons to  
choose “Create” on the  
“PlayList” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
i
t
c h  
Editing scenes on play list will not affect the scenes in  
programs.  
ay  
C r e a t  
Ed  
T
e
i
t
l
t
l
e
If the added scene had skip or fade setting, that  
information will also be added to the play list.  
You can add other scenes or remove unnecessary  
scenes to/from the create play list (see pages 129–  
131).  
The date/time when a play list was created will appear  
as the title for the play list. This title can later be  
changed (p. 133).  
If you press the MENU button before pressing A in  
step 5, the submenu will appear (see page 114).  
If free space available on disc is insufficient, creation  
of new play list may not be possible: Delete  
unnecessary scenes.  
i
e
t
ETC  
De  
ENTER  
e
RETURN  
RAM  
5
The scene select screen  
will appear: If the  
selected scenes on the  
play list are the ones  
you want, press the  
A button.  
C r ea  
t
e
P
l
ayL  
i
s
t
0 04 / 0 1 9  
ENTER  
DESELECT ALL  
RAM  
If you want to change any of scenes you are  
registering, you can also use this screen (see  
pages 109 and 122).  
127  
1<  
SWITCHING TO DISPLAY OF EACH PLAY LIST (SWITCH)  
Select the desired one of multiple play lists: The Disc Navigation screen of the selected play list will  
appear.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
4
Use the “Switch  
0 1 8 / 30 / 2006  
1 2 : . . 001 / 008  
Playlist” screen to select  
the play list you wish to  
display, and then press  
the A button.  
Use the f/e/d/  
P l a y L  
i
s
t
PLAY  
RAM  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Switch” on the  
“PlayList” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
P
l
a y  
C r e a t e  
The Disc Navigation  
screen of the selected play list will be  
displayed.  
Ed  
i
t
t
l
e
T
i
e
ETC  
D e l  
ENTER  
t e  
RETURN  
RA  
M
Note:  
To display the Disc Navigation screen showing all  
programs (all recorded scenes), choose “All Programs”  
on the “Switch PlayList” screen.  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
P
l
l a y L  
i
s
t
A
l
Pr og r  
a
m
s
01  
02  
03  
8 / 3 0 / 2006  
12 : 30PM  
9
/
10 / 2006  
8
: 00AM  
9
/
12 / 2006  
9
: 30AM  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Editing on play list  
When making settings on play list, such as  
changing title, setting skip, adding fade, etc., use  
the same procedure for setting on program or  
scenes. Perform these settings, referring to the  
following reference pages:  
Deleting scene,  
Changing thumbnail,  
Setting skip,  
p. 113  
p. 119  
p. 118  
p. 117  
p. 116  
p. 115  
p. 120  
p. 125, 133  
p. 132  
Adding fade,  
Combining scenes,  
Dividing a scene,  
Copying to card,  
Changing title,  
Arranging order of scenes  
(only on play list)  
1<  
PLAYING BACK A PLAY LIST (PLAY)  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
4
Use the “Start Playlist”  
screen to select the play  
list to be played back,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Use the f/e/d/  
1 2  
:
30PM  
P l a y L  
i
s
t
8 / 30 / 20 06  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Play” on the  
“PlayList” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
P
l
a y  
C r e a t e  
The selected play list  
Ed  
i
t
t
l
e
will be played back from the first scene. To  
cancel playback midway, press the C button:  
The Disc navigation screen of the play list  
being played back will appear.  
T
i
e
ETC  
D e l  
ENTER  
t e  
RETURN  
RA  
M
S
t
a
r
t
P
l a y L  
i
s
t
Note:  
If “Repeat Play: On” is specified, the play list will be  
repeatedly played back (see page 139).  
01  
02  
03  
04  
8 / 3 0 / 2006  
12 : 30PM  
9
9
9
/
/
/
10 / 2006  
12 / 2006  
20 / 2006  
RETURN  
8
9
3
: 00A  
M
: 30A  
M
M
: 15P  
ENTER  
128  
1<  
ADDING SCENES TO PLAY LIST (EDITING PLAY LIST)  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
Press the e button to move the cursor to the  
lower row, and press the d or c button to  
select the point where the scene is to be  
inserted.  
Use the f/e/d/  
P l a y L  
i
s
t
c/A buttons to  
choose “Edit” on the  
“PlayList” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Sw  
i
t
c h  
Ed  
i
t
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
P
l
a y  
C r e a t e  
A
l
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 8 / 0 0 8  
Ed  
i
t
t
l
e
Scene to be added  
Insertion position  
T
i
e
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
N
o .  
0
1
ETC  
D e l  
ENTER  
t e  
RETURN  
RAM  
ADD  
EX I T  
4
Use the play list select  
screen to select the play  
list to which you wish  
to add scenes, and then  
press the A button.  
Ed  
i
t
P
l a y L  
i
s
t
*1 *2  
*1: Number of scene before insertion position cursor  
*2: Number of all scenes on play list  
01  
02  
03  
04  
8 / 3 0 / 2006  
12 : 30PM  
9
9
9
/
/
/
10 / 2006  
12 / 2006  
20 / 2006  
RETURN  
8
9
3
: 00A  
M
: 30A  
M
M
: 15P  
ENTER  
6
Press the f button to move the cursor to the  
upper row, and press the d or c button to  
point the cursor to the scene to be added.  
The scenes of the  
program that was  
displayed in step 1 will  
appear in the upper  
row, and the scenes of  
selected play list will  
appear in the lower  
row.  
Ed  
i
t
l
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
7
8
Press the A button to copy the scene.  
A
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
N
o . 0 1  
After adding scenes is completed, the edited  
play list will appear.  
Repeat steps 5 – 7 to add other scenes.  
ADD  
EX I T  
Press the C button: The screen for verifying  
exit will appear.  
Note:  
If the DISPLAY button is  
pressed when the  
Ed  
i
t
l
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
A
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 8 / 0 0 8  
thumbnails are displayed,  
the recording date/time of  
the selected scene will  
appear across the bottom  
of screen. Press DISPLAY  
button again to restore the  
previous screen.  
Note:  
The cursor shows the position where the scene is to  
be added.  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
N
1
o . 0 1  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
Pressing C in the middle of adding scenes will display  
the screen for verifying an exit from “Edit PlayList”.  
Choose “YES” to exit the edition of play list. Choosing  
“NO” will restore the “Edit PlayList” screen.  
If you press the MENU button in step 5 or 6, the  
submenu screen for editing play list will appear. You  
can also use this submenu to add scenes (see  
page 114).  
8
/ 3 0 / 2006  
2
:
3 0: 0 0PM  
Recording date/time  
129  
1<  
DELETING SCENES FROM PLAY LIST (EDITING PLAY LIST)  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
4
Press the A button.  
Ed  
i
A
t
l
P
l a yL  
P r o g r ams  
i
s
t
l
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
Display the editing screen of the play list to  
be edited.  
Repeat steps 3 and 4 to  
delete other scenes.  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No . 02  
EX I T  
DELETE  
Perform steps 2 – 4 on page 129.  
Move the cursor to the  
5
Press the C button: The  
screen for verifying exit  
will appear.  
3
Ed  
i
t
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
play list in lower row,  
and place the cursor on  
the scene to be deleted.  
A
l
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 8 / 0 0 8  
Note:  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
Place the cursor on scene to be deleted, and then  
press the DELETE button on remote control: You can  
also delete the scene on the play list.  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
N
o .  
0
2
DELETE  
EX I T  
1<  
ADDING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR EDITING (EDITING PLAY LIST)  
You can use the menu screen to add scenes to a play list.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
5
6
Press the MENU button.  
Display the editing screen of the play list to  
be edited.  
Choose “Add”, and  
then press the A  
button.  
Ed  
i
t
a ms  
Add  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
Ex  
i
t
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No . 0  
3
Perform steps 2 – 4 on page 129.  
Repeat steps 3 – 6 to  
add other scenes.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
3
4
From the play list in lower row, select the  
position where you wish to insert a scene.  
7
Press the C button: The  
screen for verifying exit  
will appear.  
Select the scenes to be added from the upper  
row.  
Ed  
i
t
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
A
l
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 8 / 0 0 8  
Ed  
i
A
t
l
P
l a yL  
P r o g r ams  
i
s
t
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No . 03  
l
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
Scene to be added  
Insertion position  
ADD  
EX I T  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No . 03  
ADD  
EX I T  
Note:  
The selected scenes will be added in the insertion  
position.  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
130  
1<  
DELETING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR EDITING (EDITING PLAY LIST)  
You can delete scenes from play list on the editing screen.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
5
Choose “Delete” on the  
“Edit” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
Ed  
i
t
s  
De l e t e  
0 0 1 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
Ex  
i
t
Display the editing screen of the play list to  
be edited.  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No .  
0
4
ENTER  
RETURN  
Perform steps 2 – 4 on page 129.  
Move the cursor to the  
Repeat steps 3 – 5 other  
scenes can be deleted.  
3
4
Ed  
i
t
P
l a yL  
i
s
t
play list in lower row.  
6
Press the C button: The screen for verifying  
A
l
l
P r o g r a ms  
0 0 1 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
exit will appear.  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No .  
0
4
Note:  
DELETE  
EX I T  
If all scenes on play list are deleted, the play list itself  
will also be deleted.  
You can also select multiple scenes (p. 109).  
Select the scene to be deleted, and then press  
the MENU button.  
1<  
SELECTING SCENES USING SUBMENU FOR EDITING (EDITING PLAY  
LIST)  
You can specify the range of scenes when adding or deleting consecutive multiple scenes to/from  
play list. This “Select” menu item is useful when selecting consecutive multiple scenes in items for  
adding or deleting scenes using menu on page 122.  
1
2
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
4
Use the f/e/d/  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Start →  
Current”, “Current →  
End”, “All” on the  
“Select” menu screen,  
and then press the A  
button.  
S e  
l
e c t  
l
P r o g r ams  
0 0 1 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
S
t
a
r
r
r
t
Cu  
r
r en t  
Display the editing  
screen of the play list to  
be edited.  
Cu  
a
en t  
End  
Ed  
i
A
t
l
P
l a yL  
P r o g r ams  
i
s
t
P
l
l
l
A
l
0 0 4 / 0 1 4  
0 0 7 / 0 0 7  
ENTER  
RETURN  
P
l
a yL  
i
s
t
No . 04  
Perform steps 2 – 4 on  
page 129.  
ADD  
EX I T  
3
Specify the first or last scene of those you  
wish to select, and then press the MENU  
button.  
Note:  
See page 122 for the status of scenes to be  
selected.  
5
Press the C button: The screen for verifying  
exit will appear.  
To select all scenes, simply press the MENU  
button.  
131  
1<  
ARRANGING ORDER OF SCENES (MOVE)  
When using DVD-RAM, you can move scenes only by specifying “Category: All”.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
9
The screen for verifying  
move will appear:  
Choose “YES”, and then  
press the A button.  
Move Scene  
Move sc e n e s?  
YES  
NO  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Switch” on the “PlayList” menu  
screen, and then press the A button.  
Select the play list to be edited, and then press  
the A button.  
ENTER  
Choose “NO” to cancel  
move.  
After Yes or No setting, the scene select screen  
will be restored.  
Repeat steps 7 – 9 to move another scene.  
4
Select the scene to be moved.  
10Press the C button to quit.  
You can also select multiple scenes (see pages  
109 and 122).  
Note:  
If you press the MENU button before pressing the  
A button in step 7, the submenu screen will appear  
(p. 114).  
5
6
Press the MENU button.  
Choose “Scene”, “Edit”,  
Only scenes on play list can be moved.  
When using DVD-RAM, scenes can be moved only  
when “Category: All” is specified (p. 139).  
Sc ene  
“Move”, and then press  
Ed  
E f f e c  
Copy  
i
t
D
i
v
i
de  
e
t
De l e t  
Comb  
o v e  
the A button.  
i
ne  
Se  
l
e c t  
M
De t  
a
i
l
ETC  
ENTER  
7
The “Move Scenes”  
screen will appear: If  
you are sure you want  
RETURN  
RAM  
to move the scene, press the A button.  
If you want to change the scene selected in  
step 4, you can do it on this screen.  
8
Move the “ ” mark to  
Se  
l
e c t  
I
n s e r t P o  
i
n
t
0 06 / 0 1 9  
the position where you  
wish to move the scene,  
and then press the A  
button.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
132  
1<  
CHANGING TITLE OF PLAY LIST (TITLE)  
The play lists have serial numbers in the order you have created them, along with the created dates/  
times: You can change this title at any time.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
6
The screen for verifying  
exit will appear: Choose  
“YES” and then press  
the A button.  
T I T L E  
a
n
t
a
Pa  
r
k
F
i
i
s
h
t
i
t
l
e
s
e
t
t
i
n g ?  
YES  
NO  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Title” on the “PlayList” menu screen,  
and then press the A button.  
ENTER  
Press the C button to  
quit.  
0 1  
a
t
a
Pa  
r
k
001 / 008  
4
Use the “Playlist Title” screen to select the  
play list whose title you wish to change, and  
then press the A button.  
After changing the title,  
the Disc Navigation  
screen on the play list  
whose title has been  
changed will appear.  
PLAY  
RAM  
See “CHANGING  
P
l a y L  
i
s
t
T i  
t
l
e
TITLE OF PROGRAM  
(TITLE)” on page 125  
for how to enter a title.  
01  
02  
03  
04  
8 / 3 0 / 2006  
12 : 30PM  
9
9
9
/
/
/
10 / 2006  
12 / 2006  
20 / 2006  
RETURN  
8
9
3
: 00A  
M
: 30A  
M
M
Note:  
: 15P  
The registered title can be changed at any time using  
the same procedure.  
ENTER  
1<  
DELETING PLAY LIST (DELETE)  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
The screen for verifying deletion will appear:  
Choose “YES”, and then press the A  
button.  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Delete” on the “PlayList” menu  
screen, and then press the A button.  
Choose “NO” to cancel deletion.  
After Yes or No setting, the Disc Navigation  
screen of all programs will be restored.  
4
Use the “Delete  
Note:  
De  
l
e
t
e
P
l a y L  
i
s
t
Playlist” screen to select  
the play list you wish to  
delete, and then press  
the A button.  
Even if you delete a play list, the original scenes  
stored on disc will not be deleted.  
If any play list is deleted, the number of play lists will  
automatically be revised. (For example, if the No. 2  
play list is deleted, the No. 3 play list will become No.  
2 play list.)  
01  
02  
03  
04  
8 / 3 0 / 2006  
12 : 30PM  
9
9
9
/
/
/
10 / 2006  
12 / 2006  
20 / 2006  
RETURN  
8
9
3
: 00A  
M
: 30A  
M
M
: 15P  
ENTER  
De  
l
e
t
e
P
P
8
l
l
a y L  
a y L  
/ 30  
i
i
/
s
s
t
t
No. 01  
2006 1 2 : 30PM  
De  
YES  
l
e
t
e
P
l
a y L  
NO  
i
s
t
?
ENTER  
133  
1<>23  
Go To  
From the Disc Navigation screen, you can jump to the first scene or last scene.  
TOP (END)  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Use the f/e/d/  
Go To  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Top” or “End”  
on the “Go To” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
To p  
En d  
ETC  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
Al  
l
Pr ogr ams  
014 / 014  
PLAY  
RAM  
(When “End” is specified)  
134  
Disc or Card Management  
1<>3  
INITIALIZING DISC OR CARD (FORMAT DISC. FORMAT CARD)  
Initializing a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc or card will allow you to delete any recorded contents.  
Before using a DVD-RW on this video camera/recorder, you must format it.  
Be sure to use the AC adapter/charger to power the DVD video camera/  
recorder for initialization. If the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off  
during initialization and the initialization is interrupted, incorrect  
initialization will result and the incorrectly initialized disc will be  
unusable.  
Before You Begin  
If you use a brand-new DVD-RW/DVD-R disc, message “Disc is not  
formatted” will appear: Initialize the disc, following the subsequent  
messages (p. 47).  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
If you wish to delete all recorded contents, it is  
recommended that you use initialization, which will  
delete all the scenes in much less time than using the  
scene delete function.  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Format Disc” or “Format Card” on  
the “Disc” or “Card” menu screen, and then  
press the A button.  
Initialization will delete all the recorded contents on  
disc or card: Be careful not to delete data by mistake.  
It may not be possible to initialize a disc with many  
scratches or dirt: Such a disc cannot be used (p. 27).  
This DVD video camera/recorder may not recognize  
some discs or cards that have been initialized on PC  
or a device other than this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
The screen for verifying “Format Disc” or  
“Format Card” will appear.  
If you attempt to initialize a disc or card in this DVD  
video camera/recorder when it is connected to PC via  
PC connection cable, the disc or card may not be  
initialized and may be unusable on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
If you choose the VR mode when initializing a  
finalized DVD-RW (VR-mode), the finalization will not  
be released. (The DVD-RW will be a finalized disc  
without any recorded data, and recording will be  
possible on it.)  
4
Choose “YES”, and then press the A  
button.  
When using DVD-RW, a screen for prompting  
you to choose the VF or VR mode will appear.  
Choose “NO” to cancel initialization.  
F o r  
m
a t D i s c  
F o r  
m
a t Ca r d  
A
l
l
d a t a  
w
i
l
l
b e d e l e t e d .  
A
l
l
d a t a  
w
i
l
l
b e d e l e t e d .  
Choosing the VF mode will release the finalization of  
the disc.  
F o r  
m
a t t h e  
d
i
s
c
no  
w
?
F o r  
m
a t t h e ca r d no  
w
?
YES  
NO  
YES  
NO  
ENTER  
ENTER  
(When using  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW  
disc)  
(When using card)  
F o r  
m
A
a t D i s c  
l
l
d a t a  
w
i
l
l
b e d e l e t e d .  
Se l ec  
VR o de  
ENTER  
t
r
ec o r d  
f
o r  
m
a t .  
M
VF  
M
o de  
(When using  
DVD-RW disc)  
135  
1<  
PROTECTING DISC FROM WRITING (PROTECT DISC)  
You can protect a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc in order to prevent recorded images from  
being erased or edited by mistake. Further recording will not be possible on protected disc until the  
protection is released.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Choose “NO” to  
cancel protection.  
After “YES” or “NO”  
setting, the Disc  
Navigation screen will  
be restored.  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
001 / 019  
Use the f/e/d/  
D i s c  
PLAY  
RAM  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Protect Disc”  
Fo rma  
P r t e c  
Ca pac  
Upd a t e Con t r o l  
ENTER RETURN  
t
D
i
D
s
i
c
sc  
Disc protect icon  
o
t
on the “Disc” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
i
t y  
ETC  
I
n f o.  
RA  
M
Note:  
To release disc protection, perform the same  
procedure as above: The screen for verifying the  
release of protection will appear.  
4
The screen for  
verifying protection  
will appear:  
P r o t e c t D i s c  
Choose “YES” to release the protection.  
W r i t e p r o t e c t d i s c ?  
YES NO  
If disc protection has been engaged on another  
device, it may not be releasable on this DVD video  
camera/recorder: Use the original device that  
protected the disc to release the protection.  
Choose “YES”, and  
then press the A  
button.  
ENTER  
1<>23  
VERIFYING REMAINING FREE SPACE ON DISC OR CARD (CAPACITY)  
You can find out how long you will be able to record on one side of disc or on card.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
4
Press the C button to quit.  
The Disc Navigation screen will be restored.  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Capacity” on the “Disc” or “Card”  
menu screen, and then press the A button.  
Note:  
With a write-protected disc (see “Terminology”, p. 166)  
or locked card, the remaining space will always be  
displayed as “0”.  
(When using disc)  
(When using card)  
Cap a c  
A p p r o x .  
V I DEO( XTRA) : 17  
V I DEO( F NE) : 26  
i
t
y
Cap a c  
A p p r o x .  
PHOTO( FINE) : 462  
PHOTO( NORM) : 924  
PHOTO( ECO) : 1848  
i
t
y
m
m
m
i
i
i
n
n
n
I
*1  
*2  
V I DEO( STD)  
PHOTO  
:
54  
: 996  
9 0%  
Cap a c  
i
t
y
:
9 6%  
Cap a c  
i
t
y
:
RETURN  
RETURN  
*1 With DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc: The quality  
mode first used for recording with disc will appear.  
*2 With DVD-RW/DVD-R disc: This will not be  
displayed.  
136  
1<  
UPDATING CONTROL INFORMATION OF DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode)  
DISC (UPDATE CONTROL INFO.)  
Disc Navigation in this DVD video camera/recorder handles information on scenes, such as  
thumbnail, skip, fade, in a particular manner. If you use another device to edit a disc recorded on this  
DVD video camera/recorder, and then use the data again with Disc Navigation in this DVD video  
camera/recorder, the Disc Navigation may not appear normally. If this happens, use the Update  
Control Info function to update the data.  
When using the AC adapter/charger to power the DVD video camera/  
recorder for updating control information, make sure that power is not  
turned off during updating: If the DVD video camera/recorder is turned  
off during updating and the updating is interrupted, the control  
information will not be updated correctly.  
Before You Begin  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
It may take time to update the control information if  
the disc has many recorded scenes.  
Even if control information is updated, some discs will  
be unusable on Disc Navigation of this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Update Control Info.” on the “Disc”  
menu screen, and then press the A button.  
The screen for verifying “Update Control  
Info.” will appear.  
4
Choose “YES”, and then  
press the A button.  
Upda te Con  
t
r
o
l
I
n
f o.  
Upda te Con  
YES  
t
r
o
l
I
n
f o?  
The message for  
NO  
proceeding will appear,  
and then the Disc  
ENTER  
Navigation menu  
screen will be restored.  
A black screen may appear while the message  
for updating is displayed.  
Choose “NO” to cancel updating.  
137  
<>2  
FINALIZING DVD-RW/DVD-R DISC (FINALIZE DISC)  
Be sure to use the AC adapter/charger to power the DVD video camera/  
recorder when finalizing a DVD-RW/DVD-R disc. Finalization cannot be  
executed using a battery. If the DVD video camera/recorder is turned off  
during finalization and the finalization is interrupted, incorrect  
Before You Begin  
finalization will result, and at worst, the disc may be damaged.  
If you want to play back a DVD-RW/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder,  
using a device conforming to 8 cm DVD disc – such as a DVD player, etc. – you must finalize the  
disc on this DVD video camera/recorder. (See “Terminology”, p. 166)  
The date of program will appear on the menu screen of DVD player as a title.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
5
When finalization is complete, the Disc  
Navigation screen of all programs will  
appear.  
U will appear on the Disc Navigation screen  
for a finalized disc.  
Use the f/e/d/c/A buttons to  
choose “Finalize Disc” on the “Disc” menu  
screen, and then press the A button.  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
m
s
001/ 015  
The disc will be finalized.  
Choose “YES”, and then  
press the A button.  
The message showing  
F
PLAY  
R
W
VR  
4
F i n a l i z e D i s c  
F u r t h e r r e c o r d i n g o n t h i s  
d i s c w i l l b e i m p o s s i b l e .  
F i n a l i z e ? ( A p p o r o x . 2 3 m i n . )  
Finalized disc  
that the disc is being  
YES  
NO  
finalized will appear,  
and the disc will then be  
finalized.  
ENTER  
SELECT I TEM  
001 / 010  
0
0
0
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
:
:
:
:
:
1
1
1
1
1
7
7
8
8
8
/
/
/
/
/
1
3
0
1
1
0
0
5
5
6
/
/
/
/
/
2
2
2
2
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
6
6
6
6
0
0
0
0
1
6
7
8
9
0
:
:
:
:
:
1
1
1
1
1
8
9
9
9
9
/
/
/
/
/
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
0
5
/
/
/
/
/
2
2
2
2
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
6
6
6
6
*
* Will vary depending  
on the recording  
time.  
TOP  
PREV  
NEXT  
END  
Screen when viewed on DVD player  
(DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R)  
Note:  
Do not finalize a disc recorded on this DVD video  
camera/recorder using any other device.  
No recording can be done on any finalized DVD-RW  
(VF-mode)/DVD-R disc.  
If the disc in the DVD video camera/recorder has  
already been finalized, you cannot choose “Finalize  
Disc”.  
The time required to finalize disc that appears on the  
“Finalize Disc” screen is only for reference.  
The shorter the recording time on disc, the longer it  
will take to finalize it.  
The second and later finalization will be faster with a  
disc which has previously been finalized.  
138  
1
Others  
DISPLAYING MOVIES OR STILLS INDEPENDENTLY (CATEGORY)  
Scenes recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder will be displayed in the order of recording  
regardless of whether they are movies or stills. You can use the Disc Navigation screen to switch this  
display to stills only or movies only.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
4
Specify the desired  
option for display, and  
then press the A  
button.  
Al  
l
Pr og r a  
ms  
006 / 015  
Use the f/e/d/  
O t h e r s  
PLAY  
RAM  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Category” on  
the “Others” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
(When “PHOTO” is  
specified)  
A l  
V I DEO  
PHOTO  
l
C a t e g o r y  
R e p e a t P l a y  
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
All:  
To display all scenes, movies or stills,  
in the order of recording.  
VIDEO: To display only movies in the order of  
recording.  
PHOTO: To display only photos in the order of  
recording.  
When the Disc Navigation screen is finished,  
“Category: All” will be restored.  
1<>2  
PLAYING BACK SCENES REPEATEDLY (REPEAT PLAY)  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
When Repeat Play is set:  
If one scene has been specified: When playback  
of the last scene is finished, playback of all  
scenes will repeat from the first scene.  
If the range for playback has been specified:  
Playback of the scenes in that range will repeat.  
Use the f/e/d/  
c/A buttons to  
O t h e r s  
choose “Repeat Play”  
on the “Others” menu  
screen, and then press  
the A button.  
C a t e g o r y  
R e p e a t P l a y  
On  
To release Repeat Play  
O
f
f
ENTER  
RAM  
RETURN  
Use one of the following 3 methods to release:  
Choose “Off” in step 4 above.  
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder off  
once.  
4
Choose “On”, and then press the A button:  
Playback will start.  
Press the DISC EJECT button to remove the  
disc.  
Choose “Off” to cancel Repeat Play setting.  
Note:  
Press the C button to terminate playback. However,  
the Repeat Play setting will not be cancelled.  
Still images can also be played back repeatedly.  
Repeat playback will not function when playback is  
instructed from the recording pause status.  
139  
3
SLIDE SHOW (CONTINUOUS PLAYBACK OF STILLS)  
If you play back stills recorded on a card, the DVD video camera/recorder will enter the playback  
pause status after each still is played back.  
Setting Slide Show allows you to continuously play back stills.  
1
2
3
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
One still is played for approx. 5 seconds.  
With slide show, playback will start from the first photo  
on card regardless of the position of cursor.  
If you press the C button or turn the DVD video  
camera/recorder off, Slide Show will be canceled.  
Use the f/e/d/  
S l i d e S h o w  
c/A buttons to  
choose “Slide Show”,  
“Start”, and then press  
S t a r t  
the A button.  
ENTER  
RETURN  
Start: To start a slide show  
When playback is finished, the DVD video  
camera/recorder will enter the playback  
pause status at the final still.  
Pressing the C button will restore the Disc  
Navigation screen.  
140  
1<>23  
Connecting to PC  
Connecting to PC  
The CD-ROM is not provided with DZ-BX31A, but connecting the DVD video camera/recorder to  
PC via the PC connection cable will allow you to import photos recorded on the DVD video camera/  
recorder into PC.  
THE FOLLOWING ARE AVAILABLE WHEN CONNECTING TO PC  
Use the provided PC connection cable to connect this DVD video camera/recorder to your PC in  
which the software on the CD-ROM (not provided with DZ-BX31A) or generally available software  
is installed: The videos and photos recorded on the DVD video camera/recorder can be used on the  
PC.  
Before using, on PC, a DVD-RW/DVD-R recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder, you must  
finalize it using this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Using, on PC, the photos recorded on DVD-RAM disc or card in this DVD  
video camera/recorder:  
Original disc  
Application used  
DVD-RAM disc or card recorded on this  
DVD video camera/recorder  
Application on which JPEG files can be used  
Open the DCIM\100*HPNX1 folder of DVD-RAM disc or  
card.  
Viewing, on PC, DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc recorded on this DVD  
video camera/recorder:  
Original disc  
Application used  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
recorded on this DVD video camera/  
recorder and finalized  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE** or generally available playback software  
conforming to DVD video recording (DVD-VR) format (see  
Terminology”, p. 166)  
Example: PowerDVD produced by CyberLink  
Viewing, on PC, DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD  
video camera/recorder:  
Original disc  
Application used  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc recorded Generally available playback software compatible with DVD  
on this DVD video camera/recorder and  
finalized  
video (see “Terminology”, p. 166)  
Example: PowerDVD produced by CyberLink  
Copying contents on DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc recorded on  
this DVD video camera/recorder to another DVD-RAM disc using PC:  
Original disc  
Written media  
Application used  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) Another DVD-RAM DVD-MovieAlbum copy tool**  
disc recorded on this DVD video disc  
camera/recorder  
Copy the data to hard disk of PC, and then  
write the data to another DVD-RAM disc.  
Copying in program units is also possible.  
141  
Using PC to edit images on DVD-RAM disc recorded on this DVD video  
camera/recorder:  
Original disc  
Written disc  
Application used  
DVD-RAM disc recorded on this Original DVD-RAM DVD-MovieAlbumSE**  
DVD video camera/recorder  
disc or another  
DVD-RAM disc  
Capturing into PC, images on DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder, and creating a DVD video  
(DVD-RW/DVD-R) (see page 150):  
Original disc  
Written disc  
Application used  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE**  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) Blank DVD-RW/  
disc recorded on this DVD video DVD-R disc  
camera/recorder  
DVDfunSTUDIO**  
Capturing into PC, the images on DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder (see page 150):  
Original disc  
Application used  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE**  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc  
recorded on this DVD video camera/  
recorder  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE copy tool**  
*
The number may be different when recording was made on a device conforming to DCF.  
** Software stored on the provided CD-ROM.  
(The CD-ROM is not provided with DZ-BX31A.)  
Note:  
Images recorded on a DVD-RW/DVD-R cannot be edited nor can images recorded on a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/  
DVD-R be played using the software provided with this DVD video camera/recorder.  
No 12 cm DVD-RW can be used on DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
Languages compatible with each software program:  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE, DVDfunSTUDIO and UDF driver (DVD-RAM driver) can handle Japanese,  
English, German, French, Spanish, Italian and Chinese (simplified).  
3D-TitleSTUDIO provided with DVD-MovieAlbumSE can handle Japanese and English.  
®
When installing the provided software, the language on your Windows will automatically be  
®
installed: If your Windows is run on a language other than the above, the English version will be  
installed.  
142  
To Copy Still Data on PC  
Photos are recorded on a DVD-RAM or SD memory card in this DVD video camera/recorder in  
JPEG format: Use the application that conforms to the JPEG images.  
The following shows how to import photos into PC.  
With DVD-RAM  
No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
If you use Windows XP, the photos on a DVD-RAM can be imported from Explorer.  
With SD memory card  
Insert an SD memory card with photos recorded into the DVD video camera/recorder, and  
connect it to PC. Insert an SD memory card with photos recorded into this DVD video camera/  
recorder, connect it to PC, and use Explorer to import the photos.  
The photos recorded on the DVD video camera/recorder are stored in “DCIM” - “100*HPNX1”  
folder on card: Drag and drop them to PC to import them.  
*The number may be different if the card was recorded on another DCF conforming device.  
Contents on Provided CD-ROM  
The CD-ROM supplied with the DVD video camera/recorder contains the following folders  
(No software is provided with DZ-BX31A):  
To refer to the contents of CD-ROM, set the CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive of PC, right-click the CD-  
ROM icon and choose “Open”.  
Contains the DVD-MovieAlbumSE (see page 146 for  
installation).  
You can use DVD-MovieAlbumSE to play and edit the images  
recorded on a DVD-RAM, and to play (but not edit) the images  
recorded on a DVD-RW.  
Contains the DVDfunSTUDIO (see page 147 for installation).  
You can use DVDfunSTUDIO to create a DVD-Video disc from  
movies edited on DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
Contains the UDF driver (see page 147 for installation).  
Install this driver if you wish to use JPEG stills recorded on  
DVD-RAM disc, on your PC.  
Contains the Acrobat Reader (see page 144 for installation).  
If Acrobat Reader is not installed in your PC, you will need to  
install it in order to open the on-line manuals (instruction  
manual files) for DVD-MovieAlbumSE and UDF driver.  
Although the CD-ROM may contain a folder or file other than the above, they will not be needed on this  
DVD video camera/recorder unless some special instruction is given.  
143  
Read the electronic instruction manuals on PC for complete information on using each software program.  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE  
DVDfunSTUDIO  
You can read the instruction manual using either  
of the following procedures:  
Open the PDF file in  
DVDMASE 4\manual\Englishfolder  
contained on the provided CD-ROM.  
After installing DVD-MovieAlbumSE, open  
“Programs”or “All Programs” from the  
Windows “Start” menu, choose “Hitachi  
DVDCAM” and “DVD-MovieAlbumSE”, and  
then open “Instruction Manual”.  
After installing DVDfunSTUDIO, open  
“Programs” or “All Programs” from the  
Windows “Start” menu, choose “Hitachi  
DVDCAM” and “DVDfunSTUDIO”, and then  
open the electronic instruction manual in  
“Document” folder.  
To read the above manual, you will need Adobe  
Acrobat Reader.  
If Adobe Acrobat Reader has not been installed  
in your PC, start AcrobatReader\English  
\AR500ENU.exeon the provided CD-ROM to  
install it.  
UDF driver (DVD-RAM driver)  
After installing the UDF driver (DVD-RAM  
driver), open “Programs” or “All Programs”  
from the Windows “Start” menu, choose  
“DVD-RAM” and “DVD-RAM Driver”, and  
then open “How to use DVD-RAM disc”.  
Requirements of available PC  
®
®
The provided software cannot be used on Windows 98 or Windows 98 Second Edition.  
®
OS: Windows Me / 2000 Professional / XP  
Computer: IBM PC/AT compatible  
CPU: Intel Pentium III 800 MHz or higher (Pentium 4 1.8 GHz or higher is recommended)  
Operation with Pentium compatible CPU other than those produced by Intel /AMD may not be  
supported.  
®
®
®
®
®
Memory: At least 256 MB (512 MB or more is recommended)  
Free space on hard disk: At least 400 MB (does not include capacity needed to copy or edit video or  
photo data)  
CD-ROM drive (used to install software)  
Display adapter (video memory of at least 4 MB) and display that can display at least 1024 × 768  
®
pixels and 65,536 colors (16-bit colors), and is compatible with DirectX 8.1 or higher.  
®
DirectSound compatible sound card  
USB: One unused port is necessary for this product (USB2.0 port is recommended)  
Note:  
Operation is not guaranteed in the following cases:  
- Using PC with OS other than Windows® Me / 2000 Professional / XP installed  
- When operated on Pentium® compatible CPU other than those produced by Intel® or AMD®  
- When connected via USB hub  
Multiprocessor is not supported.  
Even when your PC satisfies the above conditions of available PC, malfunction may result or restriction in use  
may occur, depending on the combination of other software in PC or peripheral devices.  
144  
Installing Software  
No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
Before You Begin  
Before installing the UDF driver (DVD-RAM driver) provided with this DVD video camera/  
recorder, check to see if another UDF driver* has already been installed in your PC.  
®
*InstantWrite provided with the DZ-WINPC1, DZ-WINPC2 or DZ-WINPC2B PC kit for the Hitachi  
DZ-MV100A DVD video camera/recorder, or with the DZ-WINPC3 PC editing kit for the Hitachi  
DZ-MV200A, DZ-MV230A or DZ-MV270A DVD video camera/recorder.  
If the UDF driver has been installed, uninstall it and then install the UDF driver on the provided CD-  
ROM. Use “Control Panel” – “Add or Remove Programs” or “Add or Remove Applications” to  
uninstall the UDF driver.  
If any question messages appear that mean “This file is not used on another application. Do you  
wish to delete it together?” during uninstalling, click “No” for all such questions.  
Note:  
If your PC uses Windows® XP or 2000 Professional, set the user name to “Administrator (computer’s manager)”  
(or user name with equivalent authorization), log on to PC, and then install the software (if you do not have  
authorization, consult your system manager).  
For the software provided with this DVD video camera/recorder, no program with different version can coexist: If  
any programs with different versions are already installed in your PC, uninstall them, and then install the software  
from the provided CD-ROM. However, installing the provided software may disable some functions that were  
usable on the previously installed software programs with different versions.  
DISPLAYING INSTALLER SCREEN  
1
Turn the PC on.  
If the installer screen does not automatically  
appear, use the following procedure to  
display it:  
If any software is being run on the PC,  
terminate all the programs being used.  
3
4
Use the Windows My Computer or Explorer  
to open the drive in which the CD-ROM is  
located.  
2
Insert the provided CD-ROM into the CD-  
ROM drive of PC.  
The installer screen will automatically appear.  
Double-click the Setup.exe icon.  
The “.exe” extension may not appear,  
depending on the PC being used.  
145  
INSTALLING SOFTWARE  
1
Click “All” on the installer screen.  
4
If you do not wish to change the folder in  
which DVD-MovieAlbumSE is installed, click  
“Next”.  
If you wish to change the folder, click  
“Change”, and then choose the folder in  
which DVD-MovieAlbumSE is to be installed.  
Clicking “All” allows you to install the DVD-  
RAM driver, DVD-MovieAlbumSE 4.1 and  
DVDfunSTUDIO 2.2 all at one time.  
If any of the software programs are already  
installed, uninstall them, and then proceed  
with installing the provided programs.  
2
The screen for installing DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE will appear: Click “Next”.  
Click  
5
Click “Install”.  
Installation will start.  
Click  
3
Choose your TV broadcast system, and then  
click “Next”.  
Click  
Confirm  
Click  
146  
6
7
A message verifying whether a shortcut icon  
is to be created on desktop will appear: If you  
want to create one, click “Yes”.  
10 Click “Install”.  
Installation will start.  
If not, choose “No”.  
11 A message verifying whether a shortcut icon  
is to be created on desktop will appear: If you  
want to create one, click “Yes”.  
If not, choose “No”.  
12 Click “Finish”.  
Then the installation of DVD-RAM driver  
will start.  
Click “Finish”.  
Then the installation of DVDfunSTUDIO will  
start.  
13 After the DVD-RAM driver has been  
installed, a message that prompts you to  
restart the PC will appear: Click “OK”.  
Click  
14 The driver setup screen will appear: Click the  
“Driver and Formatter Setup” button.  
Click  
8
9
The screen for installing DVDfunSTUDIO  
will appear: Click “Next”.  
If you do not wish to change the folder in  
which DVDfunSTUDIO is installed, click  
“Next”.  
If you wish to change the folder, click  
“Change”, and then choose the folder in  
which DVDfunSTUDIO is to be installed.  
Click  
147  
15 Click “Next”.  
17 If you do not wish to change the folder in  
which the UDF driver is installed, click  
“Next”.  
Click  
Click  
16 Carefully read the License Agreement: If you  
accept it, click “Yes”.  
18 If you do not wish to change the folder name,  
The contents of agreement displayed on  
actual screen may be different from those in  
the figure.  
click “Next”.  
Confirm  
Click  
Click  
148  
®
19 Check the displayed contents, and then click  
21 If your PC uses Windows XP/Me, a  
“Next”.  
message that prompts you to restart will  
appear: Click “Finish” and then restart the  
PC.  
Installing the UDF driver is now complete.  
®
If your PC uses Windows 2000 Professional,  
proceed with step 22.  
Click  
20 Installation will start. When installation is  
complete, some notes will appear: Check the  
contents, and then click “×” at the top right of  
window.  
Confirm  
Click  
The contents displayed on actual screen may  
be different from those in the figure.  
®
22 If your PC uses Windows 2000 Professional,  
a message announcing the start for detecting  
device will appear: Click “Finish” to start the  
detection of device.  
It may take several minutes for PC to detect  
the device. When detection of the device is  
complete, a message that prompts you to  
restart will appear: Click “Yes” to restart the  
PC.  
Installing the software is now complete.  
Note:  
If software that detects computer virus, etc., has been  
Click  
installed, invalidate it.  
149  
Creating DVD Video (DVD-RW/DVD-R) from  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) Disc Recorded  
on DVD Video Camera/Recorder  
No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
Using DVD-MovieAlbumSE and DVDfunSTUDIO, you can create a DVD video (DVD-RW/DVD-R  
disc) from the images recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder, following the procedure below:  
1
Insert a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode)  
that contains the scenes you wish to use to  
create a DVD video (DVD-RW/DVD-R) into  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
2
Start DVD-MovieAlbumSE, and edit the  
scenes on DVD-RAM disc as necessary. When  
using a DVD-RW (VR-mode), playback of  
scenes will be possible, but editing them will  
not be possible.  
3
4
Right-click the thumbnail from which you  
wish to create a DVD video on the DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE screen, and execute “Export”.  
The “Program Export” screen as shown  
below will appear: Perform settings for  
export.  
For settings on “Resolution” and “Audio” in  
the “Export Mode” box, choose the options  
with “Recommendations” displayed. If you  
change the folder name in “Destination  
Folder” column, you can also change the  
folder in which the exported file will be  
stored.  
“Program Export” Screen  
Click  
Note:  
Choose “Divide by Chapter” in the “Option” box:  
Each scene of program recorded on the DVD  
video camera/recorder will be saved as an  
independent movie file so that export can be  
executed at high speed. If you do not choose  
“Divide by Chapter”, movie files may be unified  
and re-encoded, so it may take time to export  
them. DVD-MovieAlbumSE may automatically re-  
encode a movie recorded in the XTRA mode  
containing rapidly moving scenes, regardless of  
the “Divide by Chapter” setting, and it may take  
some time to export the movie file.  
Any disc on which scenes were combined (see  
page 116) on Disc Navigation of this DVD video  
camera/recorder is re-encoded, so it may take time  
to export files.  
Re-encoding may cause image degradation.  
5
Click the “Start” button to start export.  
150  
6
7
When export is complete, message “The file  
exporting was completed successfully.  
Do you wish to create a ‘DVD-Video’ disc”  
will appear. Check the small box for “Eject the  
disc being used”, and then click “Yes”.  
9
Click the Burn button: Writing to DVD-RW/  
DVD-R disc will start. When writing is  
complete, a DVD video disc will be created.  
Then the disc cover of this DVD video  
camera/recorder will open automatically.  
The cover of disc insertion block will open:  
Remove the DVD-RAM disc, insert a brand-  
new DVD-RW/DVD-R disc, and then close  
the cover of disc insertion block.  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE will automatically end,  
and the “Export to Disc” screen will appear:  
Click the “Start” button.  
If you use DVDfunSTUDIO to delete a  
recorded DVD-RW (see page 159), you will be  
able to reuse the disc.  
8
DVDfunSTUDIO will automatically start.  
The following Collect Tool will appear: Click  
“OK”.  
Note:  
The menu screen created on DVDfunSTUDIO will not  
appear on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Also, depending on the written contents, the images  
may not be playable on this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
In such cases, use a standard DVD player to display  
the created menu.  
The following table shows the recordable time on 8  
cm DVD-RW/DVD-R disc from DVDfunSTUDIO.  
Movie quality mode  
Recordable time on  
of DVD-RAM/DVD-  
8 cm DVD-RW/DVD-R  
RW (VR-mode) disc  
disc (using  
in DVD video  
camera/recorder  
DVDfunSTUDIO)  
STD  
FINE  
XTRA  
Approx. 50 minutes  
Approx. 25 minutes  
At least 18 minutes  
* The recordable time will be less than that  
shown in the above table, depending on some  
conditions, such as number of thumbnails to  
be created on DVDfunSTUDIO.  
Any scene exported on DVD-MovieAlbumSE  
will be automatically registered on  
DVDfunSTUDIO.  
You can now change the DVD menu to the  
desired style, change the title, choose the size  
of disc to be used (8 cm/12 cm/12 cm double-  
layered) and the playback method. Refer to  
the DVDfunSTUDIO instruction manual for  
details.  
A DVD video can be created from MPEG files on PC  
using DVDfunSTUDIO, but it may not be playable on  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Although DVDfunSTUDIO can handle a wide-screen  
image recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder  
as is, a wide-screen image recorded in the STD mode  
of this DVD video camera/recorder must be re-  
encoded.  
151  
INSERTING 3D TITLE IMAGES  
You can attach a 3D title to the images recorded on a DVD-RAM.  
1
2
Connect the DVD video camera/recorder in  
which the DVD-RAM to be edited is loaded  
to USB port of PC.  
The 3D title creation screen (3D-Title  
STUDIO) will start.  
You can then attach a 3D title to the top of  
program.  
Start up DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
The contents recorded on the DVD-RAM will  
appear.  
From this screen, you can cut, move scenes,  
and create a play list.  
4
Click “OK”.  
The set 3D title will be written to the DVD-  
RAM.  
Note:  
To attach a 3D title to a designated position, divide  
the program at that position.  
The attached 3D title will be treated as one scene by  
this DVD video camera/recorder. If you wish to  
combine it with subsequent scenes, use DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE to delete the chapter of the scenes  
that follow the 3D title, or use the Disc Navigation  
function of this DVD video camera/recorder to select  
the 3D title and the scenes that follow it, and combine  
them (see page 116).  
3
Right-click the top of program, and then  
choose “Enter 3D Title”.  
A DVD-RAM requires free space of several tens  
seconds to attach a 3D title.  
No 3D title can be entered while in the HDD mode of  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
152  
If no image appears on DVD-MovieAlbumSE:  
If, when DVD-MovieAlbumSE starts, no scene recorded on DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode)  
appears, or “Drive X: disc cannot be used on DVD-MovieAlbumSE” appears, use the DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE Preferences to choose the drive in which the DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) is  
loaded.  
1
Click “Preference”.  
2
Use “Device Settings” – “Drive Select” to  
choose the drive.  
If “The disc in drive X: cannot be used.”  
appears, click “Preference” on the screen.  
The “Preference” screen shown on the right  
will appear: Click the “Device Settings” tab,  
and from the Drive Name list in “Drive  
Select” box choose the drive where the DVD-  
RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) is loaded, and  
then click “OK”.  
Click  
If no image appears on the screen, click  
“Preference” on DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
Click  
Click  
153  
CREATING A DVD VIDEO (DVD-RW/DVD-R) USING SCENES RECORDED  
ON MULTIPLE DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-MODE) DISCS  
You can use the “Export” function of DVD-MovieAlbumSE to save scenes recorded on multiple  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) discs, by using PC for a video file (MPEG2 file).  
Since a video file exported on DVD-MovieAlbumSE can be created to a DVD video using  
DVDfunSTUDIO, you can write video files recorded on multiple DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode)  
discs collectively to one DVD-RW/DVD-R disc in order to create a DVD video.  
1
Connect the DVD video camera/recorder in  
which a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) is  
loaded, to PC.  
6
When export is complete, the screen shown  
below will appear: Choose “No”, and then  
click “Close” on the “Export a title” screen.  
2
3
Start up DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
From the DVD-MovieAlbumSE screen, select  
the thumbnail of the program from which  
you wish to create a DVD video, and right-  
click it to execute “Export”.  
4
The "Program Export" screen as shown below  
will appear: Perform settings for export.  
Click  
For settings on “Resolution” and “Audio” in  
the “Export Mode” box, choose the options  
with “Recommendation” displayed. If you  
change the folder name in “Destination  
Folder” column, you can also change the  
folder in which the exported file will be  
stored.  
7
Remove the DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-  
mode) disc, and load another DVD-RAM/  
DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc.  
Click the Eject button on DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE: The cover of disc insertion  
block of this DVD video camera/recorder will  
open. Remove the disc. Load another disc,  
and close the cover of disc insertion block.  
When the recognition of the loaded disc is  
complete, the contents on the disc will appear  
on DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
8
9
Repeat steps 3 – 7 to save any scenes recorded  
on multiple DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-  
mode) discs in PC.  
Exit DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
When exporting the video file on the final  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) is  
complete, remove it and exit DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE. Then insert a blank DVD-  
RW/DVD-R disc so you can use  
DVDfunSTUDIO to write the exported video  
file as a DVD video.  
“Export a title” Screen  
Click  
5
Click the “Start” button.  
154  
10 Insert a DVD-RW/DVD-R and start up  
DVDfunSTUDIO.  
To start up DVDfunSTUDIO, click Windows  
[Start] button, choose [All Programs] (or  
[Programs]), [Hitachi DVDCAM], and then  
[DVDfunSTUDIO].  
11 Register the scenes in DVDfunSTUDIO.  
All the scenes that you saved in PC using  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE by repeating steps 3 – 7  
can easily be registered in DVDfunSTUDIO  
by using its Collect Tool.  
Choose [Tool] – [CollectTool] on  
DVDfunSTUDIO.  
12 Click the “Burn” button.  
After registering scenes in DVDfunSTUDIO  
and changing the style and menu of DVD  
video menu, click the “Burn” button: Writing  
to DVD-RW/DVD-R will start. When writing  
is complete, a DVD video disc will be created.  
After writing, the cover of disc insertion block  
of this DVD video camera/recorder will  
automatically open.  
Choose  
The CollectTool shown below will appear,  
and the names of the folders in which scenes  
were saved using DVD-MovieAlbumSE will  
be displayed. Choose the folder you wish to  
read in, and click the “” button: The  
selected folder will be added to the read-in  
schedule list. Choose a folder from the read-in  
schedule list and click the “” or “” button:  
You can change the order of folders to be read  
in.  
Click “View Files” on DVDfunSTUDIO and  
choose a folder to view: All the video files in  
the folder will appear. Right-click the  
displayed video file to choose “Register”: The  
scenes can be registered in DVDfunSTUDIO.  
155  
CAPTURING SCENES ON DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-MODE) INTO PC  
You can capture scenes recorded on a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) into the hard disk (HDD) of  
PC, using either of the following methods:  
Capturing in DVD-VR format:  
You can perform playback and simple editing using the DVD-MovieAlbumSE HDD mode, and use  
the DVD-MovieAlbum copy tool to copy scenes to another DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc.  
Capturing in MPEG2 file format:  
You can use a file captured in the MPEG2 file format to create a DVD video on DVDfunSTUDIO, or  
use the file with on generally available software that conforms to MPEG2 file (no playback or editing  
of MPEG2 file is possible on DVD-MovieAlbumSE provided with this DVD video camera/recorder).  
To capture in DVD-VR format  
1
Connect to PC the DVD video camera/  
recorder in which a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW  
(VR-mode) is loaded.  
4
Click “Start”.  
A folder called DVD_RTAV will be created in  
the copy destination folder.  
2
Start up the DVD-MovieAlbumSE copy tool.  
After capturing scenes in the DVD-VR  
format, you can perform playback and simple  
editing using the DVD-MovieAlbumSE HDD  
mode (see “DVD-MovieAlbumSE HDD  
MODE” on page 158), and use the DVD-  
MovieAlbum copy tool to copy the scenes to  
another DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode).  
Execute [Start] – [Programs] or [All  
Programs] – [Hitachi DVDCAM] – [DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE] – [DVD-MovieAlbumSE  
copy tool]: The screen shown below will  
appear.  
Note:  
The DVD-VR format data copied to PC will be stored  
in a folder called DVD_RTAV. If you delete or modify  
any files in DVD_RTAV folder using Explorer, etc., the  
folder will become unusable on DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
If “Entire Disc” is not specified for “Choose Title” in  
step 3, the data on play list, or the JPEG files  
conforming to DCF standard that were copied to HDD,  
will not be copied.  
If, when choosing the copy destination (HDD folder) in  
step 3, a DVD_RTAV folder already exists in HDD  
folder, no copying can be done to the folder: Choose  
a different folder.  
If, when copying an entire DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-  
mode), the disc has a folder or file that conforms to  
the DCF standard, a message for verifying the copy of  
such data to HDD will appear after the data  
conforming to the video recording format are copied.  
Choose “YES” when copying JPEG files, etc. to HDD.  
Choose the “DVD-RAMHDD” tab to copy  
the scenes on DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-  
mode) to HDD.  
3
Set up for copying from DVD-RAM to HDD.  
Select the drive to be copied (DVD-RAM  
drive) and the copy destination (HDD folder).  
Then click “Choose Title” to choose the title to  
be copied.  
* Note that not all files recorded on DVD-RAM/  
DVD-RW (VR-mode) will be copied to HDD.  
156  
To capture in MPEG2 file format  
1
Connect to PC the DVD video camera/  
recorder in which a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW  
(VR-mode) is loaded.  
6
When export is complete, the screen shown  
below will appear: Choose “No”, and then  
click “Close” on the “Export a title” screen.  
2
3
Start up DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
MPEG2 files will be stored in the export  
destination folder specified on the “Export a  
title” screen in step 4.  
From the DVD-MovieAlbumSE screen, select  
the thumbnail of the program from which  
you wish to create a DVD video, and right-  
click it to execute “Export”.  
4
The “Program Export” screen as shown on  
the right will appear: Perform settings for  
export.  
For settings on “Resolution” and “Audio” in  
the “Export Mode” box, choose the options  
with “Recommendation” displayed: If other  
options are chosen, it will take more time to  
export. If you change the folder name in  
“Destination Folder” column, you can also  
change the folder in which the exported file  
will be stored.  
Click  
Note:  
For export of wide-screen scenes recorded on this DVD  
video camera/recorder, the scenes will be exported in  
the 4:3 aspect ratio status. When using them on  
DVDfunSTUDIO, they will be displayed as wide images  
in 16:9 aspect ratio.  
“Export a title” Screen  
Click  
5
Click the “Start” button.  
157  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE HDD MODE  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE has an HDD mode whose copy tool you can use to either play back the DVD-  
VR format data captured onto HDD, or perform simple editing of the data.  
1
Start DVD-MovieAlbumSE and click the  
[HDD] button.  
The HDD mode allows you to perform simple  
editing, such as creation of chapter, division of  
title, export of scenes, and playback. The  
following functions available in DVD mode  
cannot be used in the HDD mode:  
Capturing video files on PC  
Deleting titles or entire groups of data  
Entering 3D title  
Deleting chapter of title  
Deleting or adding file in photo mode  
(deleting or adding folder)  
DV capturing  
2
Choose the folder containing the VR-format  
data in HDD.  
If the HDD button is clicked at the first  
startup, the HDD folder select screen will  
automatically appear.  
Clicking the [Folder] button after selecting the  
HDD folder will display the folder select  
screen: Pressing the [Register Folder] button  
will allow you to select another folder.  
158  
REUSING A RECORDED DVD-RW  
Use DVDfunSTUDIO to delete contents on a recorded DVD-RW: It will then be reusable.  
1
Choose [  
DVDfunSTUDIO.  
H
Tool]-[Erase DVD RW disc] on  
2
The window shown below will appear:  
Choose [Quick erase] or [Full erase] and then  
click [Run].  
Erasure will start.  
Click  
Quick erase:  
Erasure will finish in approx. one minute  
(only the data on table of contents will be  
deleted).  
Full erase:  
Erasure will take up to one hour (all  
contents will be deleted).  
The erasure time will vary depending on the  
speed of drive or media.  
Note:  
This operation will erase all data recorded on the DVD-  
RW: Be sure you want to erase the contents before  
starting operation.  
159  
Uninstalling Software  
No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
To uninstall (delete) any provided software that has been installed, use “Control Panel” to open  
“Add or Remove Applications”, choose the applications to be uninstalled from the displayed list of  
applications, and then click the “Change/Remove” button.  
Note:  
After uninstalling software, be sure to restart the PC.  
Cautions When Using DVD Video Camera/  
Recorder by Connecting It to PC  
Note:  
Do not use Windows® application to finalize a DVD-  
RW/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/  
recorder: The disc will become unusable.  
When formatting a DVD-RAM disc on Windows®, use  
the UDF2.01 format (2.0 if 2.01 cannot be selected)  
(see “Terminology” on page 166). Formatting with  
other standards could cause the DVD video camera/  
recorder to malfunction.  
Before processing or editing photos, be sure to copy  
the JPEG files in 100HPNX1 folder to the hard disk of  
PC.  
Ordinary data on PC can usually be written to DVD-  
RAM disc in this DVD video camera/recorder, but  
Hitachi does not guarantee the operation.  
Data may be readable or writable from/to storage  
media in this DVD video camera/recorder using  
software other than that provided with this DVD video  
camera/recorder, but Hitachi does not guarantee the  
operation.  
If the PC is started from suspend (see “Terminology”  
on page 166) (or sleep or standby) with this DVD  
video camera/recorder connected to the PC, the DVD  
video camera/recorder may not be recognized:  
Disconnect the DVD video camera/recorder from PC  
once, and restart the PC.  
Multiple DVD video camera/recorders cannot be  
simultaneously connected to PC.  
Use a reference of approx. 30 minutes at approx.  
86ºF (30ºC) or less for operation when connecting this  
DVD video camera/recorder to PC.  
- Use a reference of a continuous 30 minutes or less  
for write operation when using the DVD-MovieAlbum  
copy tool provided with DVD-MovieAlbumSE.  
- If the temperature of this DVD video camera/  
recorder is too high, writing or reading on this DVD  
video camera/recorder may be faulty. And in  
particular, note that, if an error occurs during writing  
to DVD-RW/DVD-R disc, the disc will not be usable.  
Take care that the temperature of this DVD video  
camera/recorder is not too high.  
160  
Introduction to Video Editing Software  
The following introduces the software (generally available) you can use with PC to edit videos  
recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder. The information on the product on this page is for  
reference only; Hitachi does not guarantee or endorse the operation of a given product. Contact the  
software company for any inquiries on the specifications and operation requirements of the product.  
For Mac  
PIXELA CORPORATION  
“Pixe VRF Browser”  
Information on product: http://www.pixela-1.com/vrf_browser.htm  
You can capture videos recorded on a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc using this DVD video  
camera/recorder into a Mac and edit them (capturing videos recorded on DVD-R is not possible).  
Note:  
No software is provided with DZ-BX31A.  
This DVD video camera/recorder cannot be connected to a Mac via USB. When using a DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc  
recorded using this DVD video camera/recorder on Mac, it is recommended that you use the DVD-Multi (or DVD-  
RAM) drive of the above PIXELA CORPORATION.  
A DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc written using the above software may not be playable on this DVD video camera/  
recorder. In such a case, play it back on a generally available DVD recorder, DVD player or PC.  
The information on this page is as of January, 2006. The name and specifications of a product may change. Visit  
the above website for the latest information.  
161  
Subsidiary Information  
Introduction to Optional Accessories  
CAMERA ACCESSORIES  
Wide conversion lens (DZ-WL1)*  
Tele-conversion lens (DZ-TL1)*  
Video flash (DZ-FLH3)**  
Step-up ring  
(DZ-SR3437 for DZ-GX20MA, DZ-MV750MA or DZ-  
BX31A, DZ-SR3037 for DZ-MV780MA)  
When using camera accessories, be sure to read the instruction manuals for each accessory.  
*
When attaching the wide or tele-conversion lens to this DVD video camera/recorder, you will need the optional  
step-up ring: Attach it after removing the lens hood covering the lens (see p. 58).  
** Unavailable for DZ-MV750MA or DZ-BX31A.  
POWER SUPPLY  
Battery (DZ-BP7SW)*  
Battery (DZ-BP14SW)  
*
Unavailable for DZ-GX20MA.  
162  
Removing Disc from Its Package  
No disc in package – such as in DVD Round Holder, square cartridge or caddy case – can be used on  
this DVD video camera/recorder: Remove the disc from the holder, cartridge or caddy when using.  
The way to remove a disc from its package may vary with the disc maker: See the disc instruction  
sheet.  
The following explains how to remove the discs made by Hitachi Maxell:  
REMOVING AND REPLACING FROM/IN ROUND DVD HOLDER  
1
Hold the Round DVD  
Holder with SIDE A  
facing up. While  
2
Without touching the  
recording surface, hold  
the disc edge and center  
hole to remove it.  
Release  
levers  
1
pushing the two release  
levers in the direction of  
arrows (1) marked on  
holder, slowly open  
SIDE A of the holder in  
the direction of arrows  
(2), taking care not to  
drop the disc.  
1
SIDE A mark  
2
2
Do not open  
more than 90º.  
163  
REMOVING DISC FROM CARTRIDGE  
1
Use a fine tipped pen, etc. to snap off the lock  
pins, and then remove them.  
2
While pushing the  
release levers in the  
direction of arrows,  
gently pull out the  
holder with the disc,  
taking care not to  
drop the bare disc.  
Snap off and  
remove lock pin  
Removing disc from caddy case  
1
Insert your finger  
into the hole in the  
center of disc,  
taking care not to  
touch the  
recording surface,  
and slide the disc  
obliquely upward  
so that it is not caught by claws.  
Cleaning  
Be sure to set the power switch to “OFF” before cleaning this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Cleaning LCD screen and camera  
lens  
Use dry, soft cloth to wipe dirt off. When  
cleaning the LCD screen, be careful not to use  
force, scratch it, or subject it to impact: Doing  
such could cause a defect in the screen, result in  
display unevenness, or damage the LCD  
monitor.  
Do not use benzene or thinner to  
clean DVD video camera/recorder  
case  
The coating of case could peel off or the case  
could deteriorate. Wipe off dirt on the case with  
a moist cloth which has been completely wrung  
out. When using chemical cleaning cloth, follow  
instructions for use.  
If dust adheres to the viewfinder  
lens, remove it using a cotton  
swab, etc.  
Do not rub the lens with force: Doing so could  
scratch the lens.  
164  
Changing Setting of Demonstration  
This DVD video camera/recorder is equipped with a demonstration function.  
The default at purchase time is “Auto”, which will automatically start the demonstration approx. three  
minutes after the DVD video camera/recorder is turned on.  
Use the following procedure if you wish to view the demonstration immediately or change the setting  
to “Off”.  
1
2
Press the MENU button.  
Note:  
You can press the DISC NAVIGATION button to stop  
demonstration midway: The Disc Navigation screen  
will appear.  
Choose “Initial Setup”,  
“Demo Mode”, and  
then press the A  
button.  
I n i  
t
i
a l S e t u p  
Beep  
If you choose “Auto”, the demonstration will not start if  
a disc is loaded with the power switch set to “O” or  
N”, or a card is loaded with the power switch set to  
P”.  
The demonstration function will not work when the  
DVD video camera/recorder is connected to PC.  
While the demonstration is being given, the recording  
indicator will blink.  
Power Save  
Re c o r d LED  
Language  
Demo Mode  
Reset  
A u t o  
O f  
S t a r  
f
t
ENTER  
RETURN  
RAM  
3
Press the f or e  
button to choose the  
desired option, and then press the A  
button.  
Auto: To start demonstration approx. 3  
minutes after turning the DVD video  
camera/recorder on.  
To set demonstration to off.  
Off:  
Start: To start demonstration immediately.  
Press the MENU button again: The menu  
screen will disappear.  
To stop the demonstration midway, press the  
C button.  
The demo mode will end when the DVD  
video camera/recorder is turned off or the  
DISC EJECT button is pressed down.  
165  
Terminology  
DISC PROTECT:  
This disables writing to disc (protects disc from writing) so that images recorded on DVD-RAM/  
DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc cannot be accidentally deleted and the disc cannot be initialized.  
DOLBY DIGITAL:  
An audio recording format widely used for DVD video. Using this technology instead of PCM  
recording can enhance the recording capacity, which will allow user to achieve a recording of images  
with higher resolution (bit rate) or a longer recording time.  
DVD PLAYER:  
This device can play back video and audio signals recorded on DVD-Video and DVD-R discs using  
the DVD video format. Most DVD players can play back a DVD-R disc recorded on the DVD video  
camera/recorder (some DVD players cannot play back the disc).  
DVD-R DISC:  
One-time recordable DVD disc: The recorded contents cannot be deleted or overwritten. If  
recordable space remains on the disc, additional recording will be possible if the disc has not been  
finalized.  
DVD-RAM DISC:  
Rewritable DVD disc.  
DVD RECORDER:  
This device can record video and audio on any recordable DVD disc, such as DVD-RAM, that  
conforms to the DVD video recording format. Some DVD recorders can record on a DVD-R disc  
conforming to DVD video format. A DVD recorder that is compatible with 8 cm DVD-RAM can play  
back DVD-RAM discs recorded on the DVD video camera/recorder.  
DVD-RW DISC:  
Re-recordable DVD disc: You can choose DVD video format (VF mode) or DVD video recording  
format (VR mode) when recording on it.  
DVD VIDEO (DVD-VF) FORMAT:  
This application format establishes the file name, directory structure, data format, etc. to record  
videos (movies). A generally available DVD video conforms to this format.  
DVD VIDEO RECORDING (DVD-VR) FORMAT:  
Format to record video data on writable DVD disc: This format has been adopted for DVD video  
camera/recorders, and DVD recorders that are compatible with DVD-RAM/DVD-RW disc, etc.  
166  
FINALIZE:  
This process makes a DVD-RW/DVD-R disc recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder playable  
on a DVD player, etc. that conforms to 8 cm DVD: No further recording can be made on a finalized  
disc.  
HOWLING:  
This phenomenon occurs as follows: When the DVD video camera/recorder is connected to a device,  
such as TV, the audio input to the microphone of DVD video camera/recorder is amplified and  
output from the speakers of TV, and the signal is again input to the microphone: This is repeated to  
form an endless loop of audio signal, and the signal is amplified up to the audio output amplitude  
limit of the device. Howling can be prevented by changing the positional relationship between the  
DVD video camera/recorder and TV, or by turning down the volume on TV.  
INFRARED SENSOR:  
This sensor is used to adjust the white balance.  
LASER PICKUP BLOCK:  
This block emits laser beam to a disc, and then collects the laser beam reflected from the disc to  
convert it to an electric signal. The block consists of a laser, lens, receiving element, etc.  
LINEAR PCM:  
Audio recording format similar to Dolby Digital: However, linear PCM does not compress an audio  
signal, but instead samples it and converts it to a digital signal to be recorded. Therefore, the amount  
of data used is larger than that of Dolby Digital.  
SCENE:  
Video (movie): “One scene” refers to images recorded from one press of REC button until recording  
is stopped by pressing the REC button again.  
Photo (still): “One scene” refers to a single photo recording by pressing the PHOTO button.  
167  
SD MEMORY CARD:  
This is a standard of memory card developed in 1999. The card is 32 mm long × 24 mm wide × 2.1  
mm thick, and has 9 pins.  
SLOT-IN TYPE PC:  
PC that has a DVD drive into/from which a DVD is directly inserted or ejected without using a tray.  
SUSPENDING PC:  
This function stores the status of PC before it is turned off: It will restart the work from the status  
immediately before PC was turned off, when the PC is turned on next time.  
THUMBNAIL:  
This refers to a reduced screen displayed on Disc Navigation in order to identify the recorded image  
contents.  
UDF2.01 FORMAT:  
UDF stands for Universal Disc Format: This is a world standard file format for optical storage  
defined by OSTA*. UDF revision 2.0 or 2.01 has been adopted for DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode)  
disc to ensure compatibility with DVD recorders and PCs, as well as DVD video camera/recorders.  
* Optional Storage Technology Association: An organization that is promoting writable optical  
storage.  
VIDEO SELECTOR:  
This device can input multiple audio and video signals, and select the desired audio and video  
signals among those input signals, to output them.  
168  
No DVD Video Camera/Recorder Operation –  
Check the Following:  
Check 1  
No movie can be recorded  
Skip or search playback does  
not work well  
Check 3  
Movie can be recorded only on disc.  
Check the following:  
Is proper type of disc inserted?  
Is power switch set to “O”?  
Is the DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc in  
DVD video camera/recorder write-protected?  
Release the write-protect.  
If the temperature inside the DVD video camera/  
recorder is high, normal operation may not be  
possible. Turn the DVD video camera/recorder off,  
wait for a few moments, and then turn it on again  
for operation.  
When using DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc:  
Has the disc been finalized?  
Does disc have remaining recording space?  
If movie still cannot be recorded after the above  
check is clear, the disc may be damaged: Use  
another disc.  
• No operation can be  
performed because the  
ACCESS/PC or CARD  
ACCESS indicator on this  
DVD video camera/recorder  
remains lit or blinking.  
Check 4  
• After disc or card is  
inserted, it takes some time  
until recording is possible.  
Check 2  
No still can be recorded  
Still can be recorded only on DVD-RAM disc or SD  
memory card.  
Check the following:  
Is proper type of disc or card inserted?  
Is power switch set to match the recording  
medium?  
When using DVD-RAM disc: Set to “N”.  
If the LOCK switch on this DVD video camera/  
recorder is set to L (upper position), set it to  
K (lower position).  
In the following cases, it will take more time than  
usual until operation is possible:  
Immediately after a disc or card is reinserted.  
When a long time has elapsed since the DVD  
video camera/recorder was turned off last.  
When the temperature is greatly different from  
the status of previous recording.  
When disc with scratches, dirt or fingerprints is  
inserted.  
If the LOCK switch is set to L (upper position),  
switching to “N” is not possible.  
When disc is subject to severe vibrations.  
When the battery or DC power cord was  
disconnected instead of following the correct  
procedure using power switch to turn the DVD  
video camera/recorder off.  
When using SD memory card: Set to “P”.  
Is loaded DVD-RAM disc write-protected?  
When using SD memory card: Is the erase  
prevention switch locked? (p. 28)  
Does disc or card have remaining recording  
space?  
If still cannot be recorded after the above check is  
clear, the disc or card may be damaged: Use  
another disc or card.  
169  
No DVD video camera/recorder  
operation  
No image appears on the LCD  
screen or in the viewfinder  
Check 5  
Check 7  
Is a fully charged battery attached?  
Is the DVD video camera/recorder powered from  
AC outlet?  
Is DVD video camera/recorder connected to PC  
using PC connection cable?  
Unplug the PC connection cable.  
Does DVD video camera/recorder stop at the  
end of the scene to which wipe-out was set and  
played back?  
Check 6  
No image in viewfinder  
Is LCD monitor open?  
Press the DISC NAVIGATION button.  
No image will appear in viewfinder unless the LCD  
monitor is closed and securely locked to DVD  
video camera/recorder.  
170  
Trouble Messages  
A message may appear while you are operating the DVD video camera/recorder. If a message  
appears, refer to the following table and take appropriate corrective action.  
Messages are arranged in alphabetical order.  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
(1) Data error in a part It is possible that the system cannot normally complete writing of  
of image file. Repair  
data now?  
file when power is turned off for some reason during recording or  
editing (deleting, dividing or combining scenes, or creating play  
(2) Found error in image list). Selecting “YES” will automatically repair the video file, but  
file. Repair data now?  
(3) Data error in all  
image file. Repair all  
data now?  
even if “NO” is selected, the same message will appear when the  
DVD video camera/recorder is turned on next time. (Do not  
remove the disc while the DVD video camera/recorder is  
recognizing it: Ignoring this will deactivate the file repair function.)  
Follow the instructions on screen, taking note of the following  
cautions:  
Repair will normally be complete in several minutes, but it may  
take longer (up to one hour).  
Be sure to use the AC adapter/charger to power the DVD video  
camera/recorder when repairing data: Repair is not possible  
using a battery. If a battery has been attached, turn the power  
switch off once, connect the AC adapter/charger, and then start  
repairing.  
Data may not be repaired, depending on the timing when  
power was turned off.  
Data may not be repaired normally if data recorded on another  
recorder is mixed in.  
The repaired data may be different from the original recorded  
content because of partial deletion of defective portion.  
Since the date/time for repair is added to the repaired data  
(only the corrected portion for partial repair), the original date/  
time information will be lost.  
Since all movies, and then all stills, are repaired, the order of  
recorded contents will be lost in case of message (2) (3) only.  
See *1 on page 177.  
(1) Disc is not  
DVD-RW/DVD-R disc that was not initialized for camera use was  
formatted. If it formats, it inserted.  
becomes possible to  
use for camera.  
(2) However, when you  
record from PC  
connection terminal,  
please do not format.  
(3) All data will be  
47  
deleted. Select record  
format. (Displayed only  
when DVD-RW is used)  
(4) Format the disc  
now? (Displayed only  
when DVD-R is used)  
Battery is almost empty. Replace with a charged battery, or use AC adapter/charger to  
40, 44  
Replace it.  
power the DVD video camera/recorder.  
171  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
Cannot combine scene. Unless consecutive scenes are selected, they cannot be  
combined.  
116  
Cannot combine scene Scenes in different programs (different recording dates) cannot  
of multiple programs.  
Create Playlist first, and scenes on the playlist.  
then combine scenes.  
be combined. Create a Playlist first, and then combine such  
116  
Cannot combine.  
Deselect PHOTO  
scenes.  
Select only movies and combine them.  
116  
116  
Cannot combine. Select Select a range of at least 2 scenes to be combined, and then  
multiple scenes.  
combine them.  
Cannot delete scenes. This may occur when scene that was edited for division, etc. is to  
be deleted.  
113, 116  
Combine the divided scenes, and then delete them.  
Cannot execute.  
Change display  
category to ALL.  
This message will appear if you attempt to combine or move  
scenes with “Category: VIDEO or PHOTO” specified.  
139  
109  
Cannot execute.  
Unselect multiple  
scenes.  
Division or change in thumbnail was executed when multiple  
scenes were selected.  
Cannot read disc.  
Check dirt/crack/both-  
Error occurred while the disc was being recognized. Make sure  
that there is no scratch or dirt on disc, that the surface/back of  
27, 46  
sides contrary/inserted disc is not reversed, and that the disc is firmly pushed against the  
correctly.  
turntable. See *3 on page 177 for troubleshooting.  
CANNOT RECORD  
PHOTOS  
Are you using DVD-RW/DVD-R disc? You cannot record still  
image on DVD-RW/DVD-R disc (recordable of still images from  
PC). Use DVD-RAM disc to record still images.  
24, 31  
119  
Cannot replace  
thumbnail on PHOTO  
scenes.  
The thumbnail of a still cannot be changed.  
Select a movie.  
Cannot select any more The maximum number of selectable scenes is 999.  
scenes.  
122  
CARD ALMOST FULL Remaining space is only enough to record less than 10 stills.  
Delete unnecessary stills and try the card, or use another card.  
30, 113, 136  
Card error has  
occurred.  
Format the card now?  
Was the card formatted on PC? Was formatting interrupted  
midway? When using the card on this DVD video camera/  
recorder, choose “YES” and format it.  
135  
28  
Card error has  
occurred.  
Formatting is not  
complete.  
The card may be damaged: Use another card.  
Card error.  
The card terminals may be dirty: Wipe off dirt, and try the card  
again, or use another card.  
28  
Data other than still image may be included: Use another card.  
Card error has  
occurred. Keep card  
inside & restart.  
Card error could have occurred during editing of scenes. Turn off  
the DVD video camera/recorder with the card being used inside,  
connect the AC adapter/charger, and then power the DVD video  
camera/recorder again. Repair of scenes will be attempted.  
44, 45  
172  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Card full.  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
Delete unnecessary stills and try the card, or use another card.  
30, 113  
No more recording on this card can be done: Delete unnecessary  
stills or use another card.  
Card full.  
Cannot execute.  
Delete unnecessary stills and try the card, or use another card.  
30, 113  
135  
Card is not formatted.  
Format the card now?  
Was the card formatted on PC? When using the card on this DVD  
video camera/recorder, choose “YES” and format it.  
CHECK DISC  
A disc unusable on this DVD video camera/recorder may have  
been inserted or the disc may be damaged.  
26, 136  
Make sure that the type of disc is correct, and make sure that the  
disc is not write-protected.  
Control Information  
Error.  
Mismatch may occur between the recorded image and scene  
information.  
Update the control information.  
137  
Use another disc.  
See *3 on page 177.  
COPY PROTECTED  
DISC ACCESS  
The video signal input to this DVD video camera/recorder may be  
copy-guarded.  
Some prerecorded video materials, such as movies, are guarded  
against copying.  
Copy-guarded materials cannot be recorded on this DVD video  
camera/recorder.  
84  
The recorded scene is being stored on disc.  
Wait until the message disappears, and you can start to use the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
50, 52  
169  
This DVD video camera/recorder is verifying whether the correct  
disc has been inserted.  
Wait until the message disappears, and you can start to use the  
DVD video camera/recorder.  
DISC ALMOST FULL  
Remaining free space on disc is less than 1 minute of video or 10  
photos: Delete unnecessary scenes or use another disc.  
29, 113  
138  
Disc error has occurred. Disc error occurred during finalizing, and finalizing failed.  
Finalizing is not  
Replace the disc.  
complete.  
See *3 on page 177.  
Disc error has occurred. Has the disc been initialized on PC? Has initializing the disc on  
Format the disc now?  
PC been interrupted?  
Choose “YES” and initialize the disc when using it on this DVD  
video camera/recorder. Initializing the disc will erase all data on  
135  
it.  
See *2 on page 177.  
Disc error has occurred. The disc may be dirty.  
Formatting is not  
complete.  
Remove the disc and wipe off fingerprints, dust, etc. before  
reusing it, or use another disc.  
This message may also appear if you insert a disc for which  
formatting was interrupted midway. In this case, use another disc.  
27, 135  
44  
Disc error has occurred. Disc error could have occurred during editing of scenes.  
Keep disc inside &  
restart.  
Turn off the DVD video camera/recorder with the disc being used  
in it, connect AC adapter/charger, and then power the DVD video  
camera/recorder again. Repair of scenes will be tried.  
173  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Disc error.  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
Use another disc.  
25, 27  
See *3 on page 177.  
Mismatch in recording information may be caused by editing  
done on some device other than this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
135  
Initialize the disc or use another disc.  
Initializing the disc will erase all data on it.  
Disc full. Cannot  
execute.  
Delete unnecessary scenes before using this disc, or use another  
disc.  
113  
Disc has no data.  
This message will appear when an attempt is made to execute  
playback or editing on Disc Navigation with no scene recorded.  
Disc has no Play List.  
Switching of play list was selected with no play list stored.  
128  
Disc includes protected The disc may be software protected from a device other than this  
scenes. Delete scenes? DVD video camera/recorder. To release this case, use a device  
that has executed software-protect.  
Disc is full. Cannot add The number of entered scenes has reached the limit that can be  
control info.  
entered, so the control information for generating thumbnails  
cannot be added.  
113, 116  
Combine several scenes or delete them.  
Disc is not formatted.  
Format the disc now?  
Has the disc been initialized on a PC?  
Choose “YES” and initialize the disc when using it on this DVD  
video camera/recorder. Initialization will delete all data on the  
disc.  
135  
See *2 on page 177.  
Drive overheat. Please The temperature inside the DVD video camera/recorder is too  
retry later.  
high, and reading or writing of the data on disc may not be  
performed normally.  
45  
96  
Turn the DVD video camera/recorder off and wait for a while. The  
temperature will be effectively decreased if the DVD video  
camera/recorder is placed in a well-ventilated spot.  
DVD-R* Disc, 16:9  
mode cannot be  
changed when Video  
mode is STD.  
With DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc, the setting of 16:9 mode  
will not be possible when the Video mode is STD.  
* “DVD-RW (VF)” will appear when using a DVD-RW (VF-mode).  
DVD-R* Disc, Input  
Source cannot be  
changed.  
Once a DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc has been recorded in  
the 16:9 mode, the input source will not be changeable.  
* “DVD-RW (VF)” will appear when using a DVD-RW (VF-mode).  
96  
DVD-R* Disc, Video  
mode and 16:9 mode  
cannot be changed.  
With DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc, the movie quality mode  
and 16:9 mode once used for recording cannot be changed.  
* “DVD-RW (VF)” will appear when using a DVD-RW (VF-mode).  
29, 96  
END OF DISC  
The disc is full.  
You cannot record on this disc anymore. Prepare another disc or  
delete unnecessary movie scenes from this disc.  
113  
115  
End scene cannot be  
divided.  
Division is not possible at the end of scene.  
Error occurred. Please Abnormality has occurred with the DVD-RAM disc to be  
replace disc or format  
disc.  
repaired. Initialize the disc before using it, or use the another  
disc. Initializing the disc will erase all data on it.  
See *2 on page 177.  
135  
174  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
Error occurred. Please An abnormality occurred with a DVD-R disc to be repaired.  
138  
28  
replace disc.  
Replace the disc.  
Finalize may not be  
Instantaneous shutoff occurred during finalizing, after which  
complete. Finalize again power was supplied and disc was inserted.  
now?  
It is unrecordable on  
this card.  
The inserted card cannot be used in this DVD video camera/  
recorder: Use another card.  
JPEG file related to  
scenes are not found.  
This message will appear when stills recorded on DVD-RAM disc  
using a device other than this DVD video camera/recorder are to  
be copied to card.  
No card.  
Insert a card.  
49  
49  
No card.  
Please insert card.  
No card is inserted.  
Insert a card.  
NO DISC  
This message may appear when the DVD video camera/recorder  
or disc is moved from a cold place to a warm place.  
Condensation has occurred on the camera/recorder lens or DVD-  
RAM drive. Do not remove the disc; leave the DVD video camera/  
recorder turned off in a place as dry as possible for 1 – 2 hours.  
7
The disc has not been inserted.  
Insert it.  
46  
46  
The disc is not inserted correctly.  
Push the disc against the turntable at the center until a click is  
heard.  
See *3 on page 177.  
Is the disc surface/bottom reversed?  
Check the surface/bottom of disc, and reinsert it correctly.  
46, 47  
130, 131  
No more scenes. Play  
List was deleted.  
All scenes are deleted from the play list.  
Since a play list with no scenes cannot be supported by  
specifications, a play list from which all registered scenes have  
been deselected will be deleted.  
Photo cannot be  
divided.  
Still image cannot be divided.  
115  
127  
PlayLists over limit.  
An attempt was made to create new play list or copy play list,  
even though limit specified for play lists in the video recording  
standard had already been stored.  
Same scenes on Play  
List will be deleted.  
Delete scenes?  
This will appear when scenes are to be deleted.  
When a play list exists on disc, an attempt to delete scenes in  
program will display this message. (This message will not  
appear if you deselect scenes from play list.)  
113  
Scenes over limit.  
Cannot add scene.  
The number of scenes entered in play list has reached the limit  
that can be entered.  
Delete several scenes.  
127, 131  
127, 131  
Scenes over limit.  
Cannot divide scene.  
The number of entered scenes has reached the limit that can be  
entered.  
Delete several scenes.  
Scenes over limit.  
Cannot move scene.  
This message will appear if you try to move a scene when the  
number of scenes has already reached the registrable limit.  
127  
Stop processing  
The C button was pressed to stop processing of multiple scenes.  
175  
Reference  
page  
Message  
Cause & Troubleshooting  
There was no scene  
which can be deleted.  
This message will appear if you try to delete multiple scenes on  
Disc Navigation when all the selected scenes have been locked.  
Release the lock on scenes before executing deletion.  
113, 121  
28  
This card cannot be  
used.  
The card cannot be used in this DVD video camera/recorder: Use  
another card.  
Please replace card.  
This disc cannot be  
used. Please replace  
disc.  
A disc that cannot be used on this DVD video camera/recorder  
has been loaded. Check the type of disc.  
26  
This disc is recorded by This DVD video camera/recorder can use only discs recorded on  
the PAL system. Please the NTSC system. A disc recorded on the PAL system cannot be  
replace disc.  
used on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Top scene cannot be  
divided.  
Division is not possible at the start of scene.  
115  
UNFORMAT DISC  
The disc is not initialized or it is damaged.  
If this message appears, be sure to initialize the disc on this DVD  
video camera/recorder before using it.  
Reinitializing even a disc used on this DVD video camera/  
recorder may be necessary (initializing will erase all recorded  
contents on disc). If this message appears, try to initialize the  
disc. If the same message still appears, the disc may be  
damaged: Use another disc.  
135  
See *2 on page 177.  
27  
Use AC adapter/  
charger.  
Finalization is not possible when the DVD video camera/recorder  
is powered by a battery: Use the AC adapter/charger for  
finalization.  
44, 138  
Use AC adapter/  
charger.  
Scene cannot be repaired when the DVD video camera/recorder  
is powered by a battery.  
Turn off power.  
If the AC adapter/charger is unavailable in handy place, remove  
the disc, use the opposite side, or use another disc. To repair the  
removed disc, insert the disc into the DVD video camera/recorder  
afterwards, and connect the AC adapter/charger.  
44  
VIDEO scene cannot be No movie can be copied to card.  
120  
28  
copied to card.  
Select stills and copy them to card.  
Write protected.  
Check card.  
A card with the erase prevention switch locked is inserted: Unlock  
the switch.  
Write protected.  
Check disc.  
A write-protected disc is inserted.  
Release the write-protect using the Disc Navigation menu.  
136  
176  
*1  
This message may also appear when dirt adheres to disc. If this message appears when a recorded  
disc is recognized immediately after it is inserted, do not repair the disc; remove it and then use a  
soft, dry cloth to clean off the dirt before using it.  
This message may also appear when condensation occurs. In this case, do not repair the disc; turn  
the DVD video camera/recorder off, wait until it dries out, and then turn it on again.  
If the repair message appears when you turn the DVD video camera/recorder on from off with a  
disc loaded after recording on it, choose repair.  
If the repair message appears when recording and playback are normally possible with another  
disc – and no condensation occurs and the disc is not dirty – choose repair.  
*2  
This message may also appear when dirt adheres to disc. In this case, do not initialize the disc:  
Remove it and then use the provided disc cleaning cloth to clean off the dirt before using it.  
This message may also appear when condensation occurs. In this case, do not initialize the disc;  
turn the DVD video camera/recorder off, wait until it dries out, and then turn it on again.  
Initialization will delete all data on disc.  
*3  
This message may also appear when dirt adheres to disc. Remove the disc and then use the  
provided disc cleaning cloth to clean off the dirt before using it.  
This message may also appear when condensation occurs. Wait until the DVD video camera/  
recorder dries out, and then turn it on again.  
This message will appear when a single-sided disc is inserted in reverse. Reinsert the disc correctly.  
(Insert the disc with the label printed surface facing the outside.)  
177  
Troubleshooting  
Check to see the following before asking for a repair. If the suggested solution still cannot restore the  
DVD video camera/recorder to normal, do not attempt to repair it yourself, but consult your dealer.  
Power supplies  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
Battery cannot be  
charged.  
Is the ambient temperature too low or too high?  
Charge the battery at 50 – 86ºF (10 – 30ºC).  
Is the battery abnormally hot?  
Remove the battery, leave it for a while to cool down, then charge  
it.  
Is the DC power cord connected to AC adapter/charger? Unplug  
it.  
40  
Has the battery been unused for a long time?  
Remove the battery, and then reattach it. If the battery is still not  
charged, it may be dead: Purchase a new one.  
If the battery does not charge after you try the above four  
procedures, it may be dead: Purchase a new battery.  
Battery weakens fast  
Are you using the DVD video camera/recorder where the  
temperature is low?  
A fully charged battery (DZ-BP14S/DZ-BP7S/DZ-BP14SW/DZ-  
BP7SW) may be discharged sooner than usual at low  
temperatures. Keep extra batteries on hand.  
42  
43  
Battery may be dead.  
The performance of battery will deteriorate if it is used for an  
extended period of time or frequently: Purchase a new battery.  
The CHARGE indicator Is the ambient temperature too low or too high?  
on AC adapter/charger Charge the battery in environment where the temperature is 50 –  
is blinking.  
86ºF (10 – 30ºC).  
The battery has possibly discharged excessively. Continue  
charging: After a while, the battery will be charged to the  
specified voltage, and the CHARGE indicator will light. Then the  
battery charge will be completed normally.  
40, 41  
Power turns off  
Is battery charged?  
immediately after being Charge it.  
turned on.  
40  
When power is turned  
on, the LCD screen will  
turn on and off.  
Power goes off  
unexpectedly.  
Is Power Save set to “On”?  
If the powered DVD video camera/recorder is left for as long as 5  
minutes without recording or playback with “Power Save: On”  
specified, it will automatically turn off to save battery power. To  
restart recording in this case, set the power switch to “OFF” and  
then set it to “O”. You can also specify “Power Save: Off” to stop  
automatic power off.  
103  
Power cannot be turned Detach the battery or AC adapter/charger once, and then press  
off.  
the RESET button of DVD video camera/recorder: Reattach a  
power supply to DVD video camera/recorder before turning it on  
again.  
41, 44, 185  
178  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
Even if the DVD video  
The DVD video camera/recorder will automatically turn on to  
camera/recorder is off, recognize a disc: Closing the cover will automatically turn the  
opening the cover will  
cause the ACCESS  
indicator to blink.  
DVD video camera/recorder off.  
47  
During recording  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
Is input image copy-guarded?  
Pressing the REC or  
PHOTO button will not Is the disc write-protected or the card locked?  
start recording.  
28, 84,  
136, 169  
Recording starts but  
stops immediately.  
Is disc scratched or does dirt or fingerprint adhere to it?  
Clean the disc. If there is still no improvement, replace the disc.  
27  
83  
Is some other AV device directly connected to the video/audio  
input/output jack of this DVD video camera/recorder?  
If the AV device is connected via several other devices, such as  
AV selector, the video signal may not be transmitted incorrectly.  
In such a case, reduce the number of devices through which the  
video signal is transmitted, or connect AV device directly.  
Are you attempting to record image from video game or PC?  
From some video games or PCs, image cannot be recorded on  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
LCD screen is hard to  
see.  
Has brightness of LCD screen been adjusted?  
Stop recording and adjust the brightness.  
101  
Is the DVD video camera/recorder being used outdoors?  
Use the viewfinder. When using LCD monitor, adjust its angle so  
that LCD screen is not exposed to direct sunlight.  
36, 37  
Unevenness appears on Did you press the LCD monitor or the area around it?  
LCD monitor screen.  
If the LCD monitor is pressed, some unevenness will occur.  
Release your hand and leave the LCD monitor for a while:  
Normal display will be restored.  
Focus is not correct.  
Is it difficult to use auto focus with your subject?  
Focus manually.  
76  
75  
Does “MF” appear?  
The DVD video camera/recorder is set to manual focus. Focus  
the subject manually, or release manual focus.  
Is the diopter control correctly adjusted if you are using the  
viewfinder as a monitor?  
Adjust the diopter control.  
37  
45  
In cases other than the above, set the power switch to “OFF”, and  
then set it to “O”, “N” or “P” again.  
An error message for  
repair appears.  
Repair is only possible when the DVD video camera/recorder is  
powered by the AC adapter/charger. Remove the disc, and then  
insert another disc: The removed disc can later be repaired by  
connecting the AC adapter/charger.  
44  
179  
During playback  
Symptom  
Reference  
page  
Cause and Correction  
Recognition of disc is  
not complete  
Is disc dirty?  
Use the provided disc cleaning cloth to clean it.  
27  
Pressing the playback  
button will not start  
playback.  
Has the image been recorded by devices other than this DVD  
video camera/recorder?  
Playback of image recorded on devices other than this DVD video  
camera/recorder may be impossible on this DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
59  
Has scene been edited on a device other than this DVD video  
camera/recorder?  
If a scene recorded on this DVD video camera/recorder is edited  
on a device other than this DVD video camera/recorder, playback  
may not be possible on this DVD video camera/recorder.  
No playback picture  
Is TV input selector set correctly?  
appears on TV screen. Some TVs have multiple video input jacks. Check whether the  
correct input was selected on TV to match the connected jacks. If  
the DVD video camera/recorder is connected to VCR, set its  
input selector to “external input (LINE)”.  
81  
Is the DVD video camera/recorder connected to TV correctly?  
Check the connections.  
80  
27  
Playback picture is  
Is disc scratched or does dirt or fingerprint adhere to it?  
momentarily interrupted. Clean the disc.  
Poor playback picture  
Was the image input from analog VCR (VHS, 8 mm) and  
recorded?  
The problem may be improved if a VCR equipped with TBC  
circuit is used for playback.  
Playback picture is  
greatly distorted.  
Was recording of external input made with “Frame” specified?  
Specify “Field” for “PHOTO Input” in record functions setup.  
98  
81  
No sound  
Is the TV volume control set correctly?  
Adjust TV volume control, and be sure to adjust the volume on  
TV.  
Disc Navigation  
thumbnails do not  
appear.  
Was the image recorded from AV input/output jack with  
interference?  
Record image with no noise or disturbance.  
180  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
Photos on card cannot This DVD video camera/recorder can play back image data  
be played back.  
recorded on SD memory card in other digital cameras conforming  
to the DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) standard. The  
range of image data normally playable on this DVD video  
camera/recorder is that with pixels from 80 horizontal × 60  
vertical to 4000 horizontal × 3000 vertical. If the pixel data is  
outside this range, blue thumbnails will appear (thumbnails* in  
the figure), meaning the image is unplayable.  
Al  
l
scenes  
1/ 6  
PLAY  
*
Fig. 1  
Even when the number of pixels is within the above range,  
playback may not be possible, depending on the recording status  
of the digital cameras used.  
DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) is an integrated image  
file format of digital cameras: Image files can be used on all  
digital devices conforming to DCF.  
It will take some time to When playing back a still, “Playback.will appear: Stills with a  
play back photos on  
card.  
large number of pixels will take some time to appear.  
181  
When the DVD video camera/recorder is connected to PC:  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
No drive icon appears  
on PC.  
The DVD video camera/recorder is not turned on.  
Check the power supply.  
45  
Turn PC off and then disconnect the PC connection cable. Turn  
PC on again, and then use the PC connection cable to connect  
the DVD video camera/recorder to PC.  
Make sure the PC connection cable is completely plugged into  
this DVD video camera/recorder.  
Error occurs in playback If error occurs with USB connection, the transfer rate is not  
of DVD video camera/  
recorder on PC.  
sufficient. It is recommended that you use a USB terminal  
conforming to USB2.0 when connecting the DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
144  
Application is not  
normally run on PC.  
Turn the PC and DVD video camera/recorder off, and try again.  
Error occurs during  
writing to disc.  
The temperature of DVD video camera/recorder is too high due  
to continuous operation.  
Disconnect the DVD video camera/recorder from PC once,  
remove the disc from the DVD video camera/recorder, and then  
turn it off. After a few moments, connect them again and write to  
a brand-new disc.  
Transfer of images  
stops.  
Connect the DVD video camera/recorder to another USB terminal  
of PC. If your PC is a desktop type, it is recommended that you  
use USB terminal on the back of PC. If you are using USB2.0  
extended card, it is also recommended that you install the newest  
version driver provided by each USB2.0 card maker.  
DVD drive built into PC This problem can be solved if the DVD editing or creating  
cannot be used after the software of your PC is upgraded, or if the UDF driver is  
®
provided software has  
been installed.  
uninstalled. However, with Windows Me / 2000 Professional,  
uninstalling the UDF driver will make it impossible for the JPEG  
stills recorded on DVD-RAM of this DVD video camera/recorder  
to be read by the PC.  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/  
DVD-R disc cannot be  
played back on DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE.  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE does not support playback or data read on  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R disc: Use generally available DVD  
video playback software to play back DVD-RW (VF-mode)/DVD-R  
disc on PC.  
144  
Error appears when  
starting DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE.  
Make sure that your PC display adapter (video card) conforms to  
DirectX8.1.  
Video written to hard  
disk of PC cannot be  
edited on DVD-  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE cannot edit DVD-VR data stored on hard  
disk of PC: Copy the data to another DVD-RAM disc and then  
edit it.  
MovieAlbum copy tool.  
Movies are not  
recognized by  
Make sure the power switch of this DVD video camera/recorder is  
set to “O” or “N”.  
45  
application in PC.  
182  
Reference  
page  
Symptom  
Cause and Correction  
The DISC EJECT  
While the DVD video camera/recorder is connected to PC, use  
button is not valid when Explorer to right-click the DVD video camera/recorder drive icon  
the DVD video camera/ and execute “Eject”.  
recorder is connected to If DVD-MovieAlbumSE is running, clicking the eject button on  
PC.  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE will open the cover of disc insertion block of  
this DVD video camera/recorder: Remove the disc.  
When the time stamp of The file system of this DVD video camera/recorder is operated on  
file in DVD-RAM is  
viewed on PC, it is  
Greenwich Mean Time (GMT), and time lag information has not  
been set. With Windows as of January, 2006, the time stamp of  
®
different from the actual file viewed on Explorer looks different from the actual recording  
recording time.  
time. The actual recording time will appear for date/time  
indication on playback screen.  
When DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE is  
A disc other than DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) is loaded in  
drive: DVD-MovieAlbumSE cannot be used for media other than  
started, “Disc in Drive X: DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode).  
cannot be used”  
Click the “Preference” button in the dialog box, click the “Device  
appears.  
Setting” tab to choose the drive where DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-  
mode) disc is loaded in the “Drive Select” column, and then click  
“OK”.  
An image that should  
have been recorded  
Click the “Preference” button at top right of DVD-MovieAlbumSE  
screen, click the “Device Setting” tab to choose the drive where  
does not appear when DVD-RAM/DVD-RW (VR-mode) disc is loaded in the “Drive  
DVD-MovieAlbumSE is Select” column, and then click “OK”.  
started.  
When executing  
If stills are included in the range of “Export”, it may take more  
time because data must be re-encoded and read.  
If “Divide by Chapter” is not chosen, it may take some time  
because data will be read while being re-encoded.  
“Export” on DVD-  
MovieAlbumSE, it will  
take time to read.  
150  
®
“Hardware Removal”  
results in error.  
Exit Windows once, and then disconnect the DVD video  
®
camera/recorder. If your PC uses Windows 2000 Professional,  
the problem may be solved if you install Windows 2000 Service  
®
Pack 3 or later.  
No USB HS (high  
Make sure that you have already installed the driver provided with  
speed) connection even the USB2.0 card.  
when USB2.0 card is  
used.  
You will need to install the driver provided by USB2.0 card maker  
in order to operate the USB2.0 card at HS (high speed).  
183  
Miscellaneous  
Symptom  
Reference  
page  
Cause and Correction  
Power does not come  
on, or no operation  
occurs by pressing  
button.  
Execute system reset (press the RESET button).  
185  
Has the DVD video camera/recorder been subjected to impact?  
The DVD video camera/recorder could be damaged. Consult your  
dealer.  
The date and time are  
incorrect.  
Has the DVD video camera/recorder been left unused for a long  
period of time?  
The internal backup memory battery may be discharged:  
Charge it.  
38  
No scene can be  
deleted.  
Is the cursor placed on the scene to be deleted?  
If the selected scene (framed in red) exists, that scene will be  
deleted even if you use yellow cursor to select any scene. Check  
the colors of cursors and bar graph on the thumbnail screen.  
109, 113  
Disc cannot be  
removed.  
Did you detach the battery or AC adapter/charger before setting  
the power switch to “OFF”?  
(Cover will not open.)  
Is the battery charged?  
Connect a charged battery or the AC adapter/charger, and then  
press the DISC EJECT button to remove the disc.  
Did the DVD video camera/recorder turn off because the battery  
remaining level ran out?  
47, 48  
Connect a charged battery or the AC adapter/charger, set the  
power switch to “OFF”, and then press the DISC EJECT button to  
remove the disc.  
DVD video camera/  
recorder cannot be  
operated from remote  
control.  
Is the remote control pointed at the infrared receiver on DVD  
video camera/recorder?  
Point it at the infrared receiver to operate the DVD video camera/  
recorder.  
35  
35  
Is the infrared receiver on DVD video camera/recorder exposed  
to direct sunlight or strong fluorescent light, etc.?  
The remote control cannot operate the DVD video camera/  
recorder when strong light strikes the infrared receiver. Adjust the  
place or angle of the DVD video camera/recorder.  
Is there battery in the remote control?  
Also check the polarities of battery. The battery could be dead:  
Try replacing it.  
34  
45  
46  
Is the DVD video camera/recorder powered?  
Turn it on.  
Disc cover cannot be  
closed.  
Is disc correctly inserted?  
Was disc inserted from wrong direction?  
Remove the disc and then reinsert it.  
Connect a fully charged battery or AC adapter/charger, and then  
turn the DVD video camera/recorder on.  
41, 44  
Operating sound is  
heard cyclically.  
This sound is heard because the disc is cyclically operated and  
does not indicate a fault.  
Some vibrations are felt These vibrations or sound are caused by disc drive: This does  
or slight sound is heard not indicate a fault.  
from mechanism.  
184  
System Reset  
If the DVD video camera/recorder does not operate normally, perform “System Reset”: The DVD  
video camera/recorder may recover to normal. “System Reset” will reset all settings to factory  
defaults. The date and time will also be reset: Set the date and time again before using the DVD  
video camera/recorder.  
1
Set the power switch to “OFF” to turn the  
DVD video camera/reorder off.  
Note:  
Do not press the reset button with undue force.  
Detach the battery or AC adapter/charger.  
2
Use a fine tipped pen to hold down the reset  
button for several seconds.  
All settings will be reset.  
List of setting items  
Setting  
Item  
Default  
method  
Camera Functions  
Setup  
Program AE  
Auto  
Auto  
On  
p. 89  
p. 91  
White Bal.  
ElS  
p. 93  
*1  
Dig.Zoom  
MIC.Filter  
40×  
p. 57  
Off  
p. 93  
Record Functions Setup VIDEO Mode  
FINE  
FINE  
Off  
p. 94  
Quality  
p. 97  
16:9  
p. 95  
Input Source  
PHOTO Input  
Self Timer  
OSD Output  
CAMERA  
Field  
Off  
p. 97  
p. 98  
p. 99  
On  
p. 100  
p. 38  
*2  
Date Setup  
Date Set  
1/1/2005 12:00AM  
M/D/Y  
Date Mode  
p. 39  
LCD/EVF Setup  
LCD Brightness  
EVF Brightness  
Color Level  
EVF Display  
Beep  
p. 101  
p. 101  
p. 102  
p. 102  
p. 103  
p. 103  
p. 104  
p. 104  
p. 165  
Auto  
On  
Initial Setup  
Power Save  
Record LED  
Language  
Off  
On  
English  
Auto  
Demo Mode  
1
*
*
“60×” will appear on DZ-BX31A.  
“2006” will appear on DZ-BX31A.  
2
Some items will not appear depending on the disc or card inserted.  
185  
Major Specifications  
CCD  
DZ-GX20MA  
: 1/3.6-inch interlaced  
: 1/4.5-inch interlaced  
DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A : 1/6-inch interlaced  
Total number of pixels  
DZ-GX20MA  
approx. 2,120,000  
approx. 1,330,000  
DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A approx. 680,000  
Number of effective pixels  
DZ-GX20MA  
Movie:  
Still:  
approx. 1,230,000  
approx. 1,920,000  
approx. 690,000  
approx. 1,100,000  
approx. 340,000  
approx. 340,000  
DZ-MV780MA  
Movie:  
Still:  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A Movie:  
Still:  
Lens  
DZ-GX20MA  
: F1.8 – 2.2  
f = 3/16" – 1-3/4" (4.5 – 45 mm)  
Filter diameter: 1-5/16" (34 mm)  
Thread pitch: 0.5 mm  
DZ-MV780MA  
: F1.8 – 2.3  
f = 1/8" – 1-1/4" (3.2 – 32 mm)  
Filter diameter: 1-1/4" (30.5 mm)  
Thread pitch: 0.5 mm  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A : F1.6 – 2.3  
f = 1/8" – 1-1/16" (2.78 – 43.3 mm)  
Filter diameter: 1-5/16" (34 mm)  
Thread pitch: 0.5 mm  
Focus  
Zoom  
Auto/Manual  
Optical 10× (DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA),  
Optical 16× (DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A),  
240× (DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA), 1,000× (DZ-  
BX31A) with digital zoom added, 40× (DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA/  
DZ-MV750MA), 60× (DZ-BX31A) for still  
Required minimum illumination  
Viewfinder  
0.3 lx in Low Light mode  
0.2-inch color (equivalent to approx. 200,000 pixels)  
2.5-inch color TFT (approx. 120,000 pixels)  
Electronic type  
LCD monitor  
Electronic image stabilizer  
Shutter speed  
1/4 – 1/4000 second (movie)  
Still recording only  
Self-timer recording  
External microphone jack  
ø3.5 mm stereo mini-jack: (a plug-in power type microphone cannot  
be used)  
Recording mode  
Movie (with sound)  
Still (with DVD-RAM disc, SD memory card)  
Maximum  
DVD-RAM/DVD-RW/ approx. 18 minutes (XTRA)  
recordable DVD-R disc  
time  
approx. 30 minutes (FINE)  
approx. 60 minutes (STD)  
(per side)  
186  
Maximum  
number of  
recordable  
stills  
DVD-RAM disc  
(per side)  
DZ-GX20MA  
DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A approx. 999  
External input approx. 999  
approx. 750  
If movies and stills are mixed on one disc, the recordable number will  
decrease.  
SD memory card  
(when using 32 MB  
card)  
DZ-GX20MA  
approx. 29 (in FINE mode)  
approx. 58 (in FINE mode)  
approx. 232 (in FINE mode)  
approx. 232 (in FINE mode)  
DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
External input  
Varies depending on the recording quality and the type of card (p. 30).  
Recording DVD-RAM/DVD-RW Movie:  
format (VR-mode) disc  
Conforming to DVD video recording (DVD-VR) format (Dolby  
Digital)  
Still (DVD-RAM only):  
Simultaneous recording, conforming to DVD video recording (DVD-  
VR) standard (704 × 480 pixels) and JPEG (DZ-GX20MA: 1600 ×  
1200 pixels, DZ-MV780MA: 1280 × 960 pixels, DZ-MV750MA/DZ-  
BX31A: 640 × 480 pixels, External input: 640 × 480 pixels)  
DVD-RW (VF-mode)/ Movie:  
DVD-R disc  
Conforming to DVD video format (Dolby Digital)  
Card  
Still:  
Conforming to JPEG (DZ-GX20MA: 1600 × 1200 pixels, DZ-  
MV780MA: 1280 × 960 pixels, DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A: 640 ×  
480 pixels External input: 640 × 480 pixels) standard  
Audio playback format  
Recording medium  
MPEG Audio layer 2, linear PCM, Dolby Digital  
8 cm DVD-RAM disc (conforming to DVD-RAM Ver. 2.1)  
8 cm DVD-RW (conforming to DVD-RW for General Ver. 1.1, 2x speed  
[2x/1x])  
8 cm DVD-R disc (conforming to DVD-R for General Ver. 2.0)  
SD memory card  
Jacks  
Video/audio input/output ×1, External microphone input ×1,  
PC connection terminal (connected to PC USB port) ×1  
Battery system  
Lithium-ion  
Power consumption  
When recording with LCD monitor off (DVD-RAM disc used)  
DZ-GX20MA  
approx. 4.4W (in FINE mode)  
approx. 3.8W (in FINE mode)  
DZ-MV780MA  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A approx. 3.2W (in FINE mode)  
Dimensions  
(W × H × D)  
DZ-GX20MA  
: approx. 2" × 3-9/16" × 5-3/8"  
(51 × 90 × 137 mm)  
(excluding projections)  
DZ-MV780MA  
: approx. 2" × 3-3/8" × 4-13/16"  
(51 × 86 × 123 mm)  
(excluding projections)  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A : approx. 2" × 3-1/2" × 5-1/4"  
(51 × 89 × 133 mm)  
(excluding projections)  
187  
Operating temperature (humidity)  
32 – 104ºF (0 – 40ºC) (less than 80%)  
32 – 86ºF (0 – 30ºC) when connected to PC  
Storage temperature  
Weight  
-4 – 140ºF (-20 – 60ºC)  
DZ-GX20MA  
approx. 480 g (without battery or disc)  
DZ-MV780MA  
approx. 420 g (without battery or disc)  
approx. 450 g (without battery or disc)  
approx. 555 g  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
DZ-GX20MA  
Total weight when recording  
Provided accessories  
DZ-MV780MA  
approx. 475 g  
DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
approx. 505 g  
AC adapter/charger, Battery, AV/S input/output cable,  
Infrared remote control (not provided with DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A),  
Lithium battery for remote control (not provided with DZ-MV750MA/  
DZ-BX31A),  
Lens cap, Lens cap string, Shoulder strap, Power cable,  
DC power cord, Software CD-ROM (not provided with DZ-BX31A), PC  
connection cable,  
Single-sided 8 cm DVD-R disc (not provided with DZ-BX31A),  
Disc cleaning cloth  
188  
To Order in the United States  
BY PHONE  
Service Hotline:1-800-HITACHI  
(1-800-448-2244)  
To Order in the Canada  
Choisissez les articles qui vous conviennent et  
passez commande.  
FOR AUTHORIZED HITACHI SERVICE  
FACILITY IN CANADA  
Service Direct: 1-800-HITACHI  
(1-800-448-2244)  
Please consult the following telephone number  
Service Direct: 1-800-HITACHI  
(1-800-448-2244)  
POUR COMMANDER DES  
ACCESSOIRES  
(Canada seulement)  
PAR TÉLÉPHONE  
TO ORDER ACCESSORIES  
(Canada only)  
BY PHONE  
HITACHI CANADA LTD.  
HITACHI CANADA LTD.  
DIGITAL MEDIA DIVISION  
DIGITAL MEDIA DIVISION  
1-2495 Meadowpine Blvd.  
Mississauga, Ontario  
L5N 6C3  
Service Direct: 1-800-HITACHI  
(1-800-448-2244)  
1-2495 Meadowpine Blvd.  
Mississauga, Ontario  
L5N 6C3  
Service Direct: 1-800-HITACHI  
(1-800-448-2244)  
during business hours  
Durant les heures de bureau:  
Lundi au vendredi 9:00am – 7:00pm (h.n.e)  
Monday-Friday  
EST 9:00am – 7:00pm  
Saturday  
EST 9:00am – 5:00pm  
Samedi  
9:00am – 5:00pm (h.n.e)  
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY  
with FCC Rules for Electromagnetic Compatibility  
Products:  
Models:  
DVD VIDEO CAMERA/RECORDER  
DZ-GX20MA/DZ-MV780MA/DZ-MV750MA/DZ-BX31A  
Trade Name: HITACHI  
This device complies with part 15 of FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that  
may cause undesired operation.  
Responsible Party: HITACHI AMERICA, LTD.  
HOME ELECTRONICS DIVISION  
900 Hitachi Way  
Chula Vista, CA 91914-3556 U.S.A  
Tel: 619-591-5200  
189  
Index  
Disc  
Numerics  
Available ...................................................25  
Capacity ...................................................29  
Finalize ..................................................138  
Format ...................................................135  
Handling ...................................................27  
Protect ...................................................136  
Update Control Info. .................................137  
1,000x (Dig. Zoom) ............................................57  
16:9 .................................................................95  
240x (Dig. Zoom) ..............................................57  
40x (Dig. Zoom) ................................................57  
60x (Dig. Zoom) ................................................57  
8 cm bare disc ..................................................25  
DISC EJECT button ...........................................48  
Display  
A
Information LCD ........................................53  
Scenes information ..................................123  
Viewfinder .................................................37  
Divide ............................................................115  
DVD player ...............................................82, 166  
DVD-R .............................................................25  
DVD-RAM ........................................................25  
DVD recorder ............................................82, 166  
DVD-RW ..........................................................25  
DVD video format ............................................166  
DVD video recording (DVD-VR) format ..........31, 166  
AC adapter/charger ...........................................44  
ACCESS/PC indicator ..................................50, 52  
Add (edit) .......................................................130  
All programs ...................................................124  
Auto (program AE) .............................................89  
Autofocus .........................................................75  
AV input/output jack ...........................................80  
B
Backlight correction ...........................................77  
Battery  
Attaching to DVD video camera/recorder .......41  
Charging ..................................................40  
Recordable time on DVD video camera/  
recorder .................................................42  
Removing from DVD video camera/  
E
Edit (play List) .................................................129  
EIS ..................................................................93  
EXPOSURE button ............................................77  
Exposure control ...............................................77  
External microphone jack ....................................78  
recorder .................................................41  
Setting Up ................................................40  
BATTERY EJECT button ....................................41  
Beep .............................................................103  
Black & White fade ..........................................117  
Brightness ......................................................101  
F
Fade ..............................................................117  
FIELD (PHOTO Input) ........................................98  
Finalize Disc ...................................................138  
FINE (VIDEO Mode) ..........................................94  
FOCUS button ..................................................75  
Format Disc ....................................................135  
FRAME (PHOTO Input) ......................................98  
Frame advance/Frame back ................................60  
C
Camera Functions Setup ....................................89  
Capacity .........................................................136  
Card  
Available ...................................................28  
Capacity ...........................................30, 136  
Category ................................................139  
Format ...................................................135  
Handling ...................................................28  
Quality .....................................................97  
CHARGE indicator .............................................40  
Cleaning ........................................................164  
Color Level .....................................................102  
Connecting to TV ..............................................80  
Copy ..............................................................120  
Create ...........................................................127  
G
Go To (during playback) ......................................62  
Go To (on Disc Navigation) ...............................134  
H
Hand strap ........................................................32  
Howling ....................................................80, 167  
I
Information display mode ....................................53  
Infrared receiver ................................................35  
Infrared sensor ................................................167  
Initial Setup ....................................................103  
Input Source .....................................................97  
D
Date and time ...................................................38  
Date setup ........................................................38  
Defaults .........................................................105  
Delete (edit) ....................................................131  
Delete (play list) ..............................................133  
Delete (scene) ........................................113, 130  
Demo Mode ....................................................165  
Detail (scene) .................................................123  
Dig. Zoom ........................................................57  
Diopter control ..................................................37  
L
Language .......................................................104  
Laser pickup block .....................................46, 167  
Lens cap ..........................................................33  
Lens cap string attachment hole ..........................33  
Linear PCM ............................................167, 187  
190  
Lock .............................................................. 121  
LOCK switch .................................................... 51  
Low Light (Program AE) ..................................... 90  
Divide .................................................... 115  
Fade ...................................................... 117  
Move ............................................. 116, 132  
Select .................................................... 122  
Skip ....................................................... 118  
Searching for image .......................................... 60  
Select (Scene) ................................................ 109  
SELECT button ............................................... 109  
Self Timer ........................................................ 99  
Shoulder Strap ................................................. 33  
Skip (Scene) .................................................. 118  
Skip playback ................................................... 61  
Slide Show ..................................................... 140  
Sports (Program AE) ......................................... 89  
Spotlight (Program AE) ...................................... 89  
STD (VIDEO Mode) ........................................... 94  
Stereo microphone ............................................ 51  
Submenu ....................................................... 114  
Switch (play list) .............................................. 128  
Switch (program) ............................................ 124  
M
MF .................................................................. 75  
MIC.Filter ......................................................... 93  
Move ............................................................. 132  
N
Normal Menu ................................................... 87  
O
Optical 10× zoom lens ....................................... 57  
Optical 16x zoom lens ....................................... 57  
OSD Output ................................................... 100  
P
PHOTO Input ................................................... 98  
Play (play list) ................................................. 128  
Play (program) ................................................ 125  
Play list ......................................................... 127  
Add scenes ............................................ 129  
Add scenes (submenu) ............................ 130  
Create ................................................... 127  
Delete ................................................... 133  
Delete scenes ......................................... 130  
Delete scenes (submenu) ......................... 131  
Move ..................................................... 132  
Play ....................................................... 128  
Select scenes (submenu) ......................... 131  
Switch ................................................... 128  
Title ....................................................... 133  
Portrait (Program AE) ........................................ 89  
Power Save .................................................... 103  
Power switch .................................................... 45  
Program ........................................................ 124  
Play ....................................................... 125  
Switch ................................................... 124  
Title ....................................................... 125  
Program AE ..................................................... 89  
Protect Disc ................................................... 136  
T
Tele-conversion lens .......................................... 58  
Thumbnail ...................................................... 107  
Title (play list) ................................................. 133  
Title (program) ................................................ 125  
U
UDF2.01 format ...................................... 160, 168  
Update Control Info. ........................................ 137  
V
Video flash ....................................................... 79  
VIDEO Mode .................................................... 94  
FINE ....................................................... 94  
STD ........................................................ 94  
XTRA ...................................................... 94  
Video selector .................................... 84, 96, 168  
Vol. button ........................................................ 59  
W
White Bal. ........................................................ 91  
White fade ..................................................... 117  
Wide conversion lens ......................................... 58  
Wipe fade ...................................................... 117  
Q
Quality (Card) ................................................... 97  
Quick Menu ...................................................... 64  
QUICK MENU button ......................................... 65  
X
XTRA (VIDEO Mode) ........................................ 94  
R
Z
Record button ................................................... 50  
Recording indicator ......................................... 104  
Remote control ................................................. 34  
Repeat Play ................................................... 139  
Reset  
Zoom lever ....................................................... 57  
settings .................................................. 105  
system ................................................... 185  
RESET button ................................................ 185  
S
Sand & Snow (Program AE) ............................... 89  
Scene  
Combine ................................................ 116  
Delete ................................................... 113  
Detail ..................................................... 123  
191  
Be sure to read the following before opening  
the package of CD-ROM  
This Agreement will take effect at the moment you open the package of the storage device (CD-ROM) provided  
with this product, if you agree to the terms herein.  
If you do not accept the terms of this Agreement, immediately return the unopened package of storage medium  
and enclosed materials (printed matter, external package, and all others) to your dealer, or return only the package  
of storage medium to your dealer.  
Consult your dealer for any refund on the unused product. However, if only the package of storage medium is  
returned, no refund is possible.  
This License Agreement certifies that you were granted license in the past.  
License Agreement  
Article 1 Grant of License  
Hitachi, Ltd. grants you the following rights for the following products (to be referred to as “This Software”  
hereafter) that you have obtained with this Agreement:  
(a) You may use This Software only on a single piece of equipment. However, if this equipment cannot be used  
because of mechanical problem, you may temporarily use This Software on another piece of equipment.  
(b) Although This Software contains several components that can be run on computer as independent functions, all  
components are licensed as a single product: You may not, by any means, use these components on different  
computers at the same time.  
Article 2 Copyrights  
The copyrights of This Software, attached manual, etc. are owned by Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd., and  
are protected by copyright laws in Japan and USA, as well as by other intellectual property and international  
properties:  
Article 3 Other Rights and Limitations  
(a) You may not copy This Software or any of the printed materials attached, except for duplications to provide  
back-up or storage.  
(b) Use of This Software by third parties is prohibited, whether by transferring, renting, leasing, lending, moving,  
or any other measures.  
(c) You may not decompile or disassemble this Software.  
(d) Duplication and/or distribution of any files on this storage medium for commercial use is prohibited.  
Article 4 Quality Assurance  
Under no circumstances will Hitachi, Ltd., Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. accept any responsibility for any  
damages you may incur from using or being unable to use This Software (including, but not limited to, loss of  
business profit, interruption of business, loss of business information, or other monetary damages).  
Article 5 Termination of Agreement  
If you fail to comply with the terms of this Agreement, Hitachi, Ltd., Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. reserve  
the right to terminate the Agreement. In such a case, you will be obliged to discard all copies of This Software and  
its components.  
Article 6 Prioritized License Agreement  
When some software programs are installed, the license agreements will be displayed (to be referred to as online  
license agreement).  
If the online license agreement conflicts with this Agreement, the online license agreement shall have a priority.  
192  
Warranty Limitations  
Important Notice:  
The Limited Warranty provided by Hitachi does  
not cover:  
Retain your sales receipt for warranty purposes.  
Please complete the section below for your records  
as it may be needed in the event of loss.  
A. Cabinet (exterior finish items), Battery  
packs, Accessories, Lens Cleanings, Head  
Cleanings, DVD Disc Damage, Video Tape  
Damage, or Software Modifications.  
B. Any defect, malfunction, or failure caused  
by or resulting from improper service,  
maintenance, repair, use of DVD Cleaning  
Disks, use of Video Cleaning Cassettes,  
software, or from abuse, neglect, accident  
or any other cause beyond the control of  
Hitachi.  
Attach your sales receipt to this card.  
DVD, VCR, Camcorder Products,  
AC Adapter Charger  
Limited Warranty Registration  
(for your records)  
C. Unpacking, set-up or installation,  
adjustment of customer operated controls,  
user instruction.  
D. Any product with Serial Numbers altered or  
removed.  
E. New products purchased or service  
performed outside of the continental United  
States or its possessions.  
F. Product used for a commercial or industrial  
purpose.  
Model No.  
NO PERSON, AGENT, DISTRIBUTOR, DEALER, SERVICE  
FACILITY, OR COMPANY IS AUTHORIZED TO CHANGE,  
MODIFY, OR AMEND THE TERMS OF THIS LIMITED  
WARRANTY IN ANY MANNER OR FASHION WHATSOEVER,  
EXCEPT AND TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED IN THIS LIMITED  
WARRANTY, HITACHI MAKES NO EXPRESS WARRANTY  
REGARDING THIS HITACHI PRODUCT. FURTHER, ALL  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES RELATING TO ANY PORTION OF THIS  
PRODUCT, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY OF  
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO 90 DAYS FOR LABOR AND ONE  
YEAR FOR PARTS, THE DURATION OF THE APPLICABLE  
EXPRESS WARRANTY CONTAINED ABOVE. HITACHI SHALL  
NOT BE LIABLE TO THE PURCHASER OR TO ANY OTHER  
PERSON FOR ANY INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES OR LOSS OF PROFIT OF PRODUCT RESULTING  
FROM ANY DEFECT IN OR MALFUNCTION OR FAILURE OF  
THIS HITACHI PRODUCT. SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW  
LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED WARRANTY LASTS,  
OR THE EXCLUSION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO  
YOU. THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS  
AND YOU MAY ALSO HAVE OTHER RIGHTS WHICH VARY  
FROM STATE TO STATE.  
Serial No.  
Date of Purchase  
Dealer Name  
Dealer Address  
City  
State  
Zip  
HITACHI  
LIMITED WARRANTY  
Hitachi America, Ltd., Home Electronics Division  
(“Hitachi,”) warrants this component in duration as  
stated below:  
HITACHI  
Hitachi America, Ltd.  
Home Electronics Division  
90 DAYS LABOR (Carry-in)  
1 YEAR PARTS (Except Battery)  
DVD Products  
VCR Products  
CAMCORDER Products  
AC ADAPTER CHARGER  
For information concerning repairs, operation,  
technical assistance or for referral to the location of  
your nearest Authorized Service Facility or Parts  
Distributor, call: 1-800-HITACHI (1-800-448-2244)  
Conditions of  
Hitachi Limited Warranty  
These Hitachi Products are warranted to be free  
of defects in parts and workmanship at the time of  
purchase by the original owner. If this product is  
found to be defective, Hitachi will repair or  
HITACHI AMERICA, LTD.  
HOME ELECTRONICS DIVISION  
900 Hitachi Way  
Chula Vista, CA 91914-3556  
Tel: 1-800-HITACHI  
replace defective parts at no charge to the  
original owner. Parts used for replacement are  
warranted for the remainder of the original Limited  
Warranty period. For 90 days from the date of  
original purchase, Hitachi will provide labor for the  
repair or replacement of defective parts without  
charge, subject to the following conditions:  
REGISTER YOUR HITACHI PRODUCT  
ON-LINE AT HITACHI.COM/TV  
(Continued on reverse side)  
1. Owner must provide verification of the date of  
purchase when requesting Limited Warranty  
Service. (Dated Sales Receipt Required)  
2. All repairs must be performed by a Hitachi  
Authorized Service Facility.  
3. This warranty is valid only in the U.S.A.  
REGISTER YOUR PRODUCT ON-LINE AT  
HITACHI.COM/TV  
OR MAIL IN TO ADDRESS ON THIS CARD.  
HITACHI  
“In order to allow Hitachi to better serve customer needs, please  
complete this card and return it to Hitachi America, Ltd., Home  
Electronics Division. Completion of this card is not required in order  
to validate your Hitachi limited warranty, but would assist us in  
developing better services and programs for our customers.”  
(Please print or type)  
Model No.  
Serial No.  
Date of purchase  
Customer Name  
Customer Address  
City  
State  
Zip  
(
)
Phone No.  
Dealer name  
Dealer address  
City  
State  
Zip  
HITACHI CANADA LTD DIGITAL MEDIA DIVISION  
HITACHI WARRANTY POLICY  
HITACHI VIDEO PRODUCTS are guaranteed to be free from defects in workmanship and material. If any failure resulting from either workmanship  
or material defect should occur under normal and proper usage within the period stated hereunder from the original provable date of purchase, such  
failure should be repaired at no cost to the buyer, provided the defective product is brought to a HITACHI AUTHORIZED SERVICE CENTER in  
Canada.  
IMPORTANT: KEEP THIS WARRANTY CARD AND ATTACH IT TO YOUR BILL OF SALE FOR FUTURE USE.  
WARRANTY PERIOD - 1 YEAR PARTS AND LABOR  
Where HITACHI service is not available, the purchaser must assume the responsibility and expense for the proper packing, shipping and all costs  
associated with the delivery to and from the closest HITACHI AUTHORIZED SERVICE CENTER. All goods returned to a HITACHI authorized  
service center must be shipped on a “PREPAID BASIS”. To avoid any damage to the returned goods, please ensure that proper packaging procedures  
are followed. A short written description of the problem along with proof of warranty should accompany the product returned for repair. Only products  
under warranty will be returned on a no-charge basis to the customer. The customer is responsible for all transport costs if the product is no longer  
under warranty.  
WARRANTY DOES NOT COVER:  
1
2
Products received for repair without sales or delivery receipt  
showing date of purchase by the original customer.  
7
8
9
Products used for commercial purposes or institutions.  
Products used for rental.  
Damages caused by incorrect use, carelessness,  
unauthorized alterations, improper storage or unauthorized  
repair or service.  
Original installation (set-up), external adjustment and all  
normal maintenance needed such as cleaning of video  
head and lens pick-up, or any software modification or  
damage.  
3
Damage caused by fire, flood, lightning, acts of God, or  
other events beyond the control of Hitachi.  
10 Products sold in Canada by any other organization which is  
not authorized by Hitachi Canada Ltd.  
4
5
Products purchased and/or used outside Canada.  
In transit damage claims, improper handling by carrier or  
post offices.  
11 The replacement of video camera pickup element if the pick  
up element has been over-exposed to an intense source of  
light.  
6
Products or parts thereof which have had serial numbers  
removed, altered or defaced.  
12 Batteries, earphone, antennas, accessories and external  
parts such as cabinet and knobs.  
IMPORTANT:This warranty is in lieu of all other warranties, or agreements whether express or implied, and no person, dealer or  
company is authorized to change, modify, or extend its terms in any manner whatsoever.  
CANADA ONLY  
HITACHI CANADA LTD  
TERMES ET GARANTIE DES PRODUITS HITACHI  
LES PRODUITS VIDÉO sont garantis contre tout défaut de matériel et de fabrication. Toute panne attribuable à de tels défauts sera réparée sans frais  
pourvu que la panne se soit produite lors d’un usage normal et au cours de la période de garantie ci-dessous qui court à partir de la date d’achat initiale et  
que l’appareil soit apporté à un CENTRE DE SERVICE AUTORISÉ HITACHI où l’appareil sera réparé sans frais.  
IMPORTANT: CONSERVER CETTE CARTE DE GARANTIE AINSI QUE LA FACTURE D’ACHAT UTILISATION ULTÉRIEURE.  
CANADA SEULEMENT  
PÉRIODE DE GARANTIE: 1 AN PIÈCES ET MAIN-D’OEUVRE  
En l’absence d’un centre de service HITACHI dans un rayon acceptable, l’acheteur doit assumer la responsabilité et les coûts pour un emballage adéquat,  
l’expédition ainsi que tous les coûts associés à la livraison de l’appareil au CENTRE DE SERVICE AUTORISÉ HITACHI le plus près. Toutes les  
dépenses encourues pour le transport ou la livraison à nos centres de service autorisés Hitachi sont aux frais de l’acheteur. Le produit doit être emballé  
adéquatement pour éviter les bris, tout en s’assurant d’y inclure une brève description du problème ainsi qu’une PREUVE validant la garantie. Seuls les  
produits encore couverts par la garantie seront retournés sans frais au consommateur.  
CETTE GARANTIE NE S’APPLIQUE PAS DANS LES CAS SUIVANTS:  
NOT VALID IN U.S.A.  
1
2
Produits reçus pour réparation sans preuve validant la  
garantie.  
7
8
9
Produits utilisés à des fins commerciales ou institutionnelles.  
Produits utilisés pour la location.  
Dommages résultant de négligence, mauvais usage,  
réparation sans autorisation, entreposage inadéquat et de  
toute réparation effectuée par des centres de service non  
Installation originale (réglage initial), réglage externe et tout  
entretien régulier tel que le nettoyage des têtes vidéo et de  
NON VALIDE AUX E.U.  
l’objectif ou toute modification ou tout dommage au logiciel.  
autorisés par Hitachi.  
10 Produits vendus au Canada par toute autre organisation qui  
3
Dommages ou pertes échappant à tout contrôle de la part de  
Hitachi tel que: feu, inondation, foudre, etc.  
n’est pas dûment autorisée par Hitachi Canada Ltd.  
11 Le remplacement du tube de prise de vues si dernier a été  
surexposé à une source de lumière intense.  
4
5
Produits achetés et/ou utilisés à l’extérieur du Canada.  
Dommages encourus suite à une mauvaise manipulation du  
transporteur ou de la poste.  
12 Batteries, écouteurs, antennes, accessoires et toutes les  
parties externes telles que boutons et cabinet.  
6
Produits dont le numéro de série a été enlevé, retouché ou  
effacé.  
IMPORTANT: Cette garantie ne peut être modifiée par aucune autre garantie ou entente, écrite ou verbale. Aucune personne,  
marchand ou compagnie nest autorisé à la changer, la modifier ou à en élargir les clauses daucune manière.  
HITACHI CANADA LTD  
VIDEO PRODUCT  
YOUR  
PRODUIT VIDÉO  
VOTRE  
WARRANTY  
GARANTIE  
HITACHI CANADA LTD  
DIGITAL MEDIA DIVISION  
1-2495 Meadowpine Blvd., Mississauga, Ontario L5N 6C3 CANADA  
IMPORTANT NOTICE: This warranty will not apply to product purchased outside of  
Canada OR sold by any organization other than HITACHI CANADA LTD  
AVIS IMPORTANT: Notre garantie ne couvre pas les produits achetés à l’extérieur du  
Canada OU vendus par toute organisation autre que HITACHI CANADA LTD  
IMPORTANT  
REGISTER YOUR PRODUCT ON-LINE AT:  
WWW.HITACHI.CA  
IMPORTANT  
ENREGISTREZ VOTRE PRODUIT EN-LIGNE À:  
WWW. HITACHI.CA  
“In order to allow Hitachi to better serve our customers’ needs, please  
complete this card and return it to Hitachi Canada Ltd. Completion of this  
card is not required in order to validate your Hitachi limited warranty, but  
would assist us in developing better services and programs for our  
customers.(Please print or type)  
«Afin de permettre à Hitachi de mieux répondre aux besoins de la clientèle,  
veuillez remplir cette carte et la retourner à Hitachi Canada Ltd. Il n’est pas  
nécessaire de remplir cette carte pour valider vorte garantie limitée Hitachi;  
toutefois, elle nous aide à améliorer les services et programmes offerts à  
nos clients.» (En caractères d’imprimerie S.V.P.)  
Model No. / N  
°
de modèle  
Serial No. / N  
°
de série  
Date of purchase / Date d’achat  
Customer’s first and last name / Prénom et nom du client  
Customer’s address - PO Box No. / Adresse ou casier postal du client  
City / Ville  
Province  
Province  
Postal Code / Code postal  
Telephone No. / N de téléphone  
°
Dealer’s name / Nom du marchand  
City / Ville  
Dealer’s address / Adresse du marchand  
Postal Code / Code postal  
What are the two most important factors that influenced your purchase decision?  
Quels sont les deux facteurs les plus importants qui ont influencé votre décision d’achat?  
How did you hear about this Hitachi, VIDEO PRODUCT?  
Comment avous-vous pris connaissance LES PRODUIT VIDÉO de Hitachi?  
What other VIDEO PRODUCTS brands did you consider before selecting Hitachi?  
Quelle autre marque LES PRODUCTS VIDÉO avez-vous envisagé d’acquérir avant d’opter pour Hitachi?  

Alpine CDE 7858 User Manual
Audiovox LCM5620PKG User Manual
Bosch Appliances Car Video System UML 192 90 User Manual
Bryan Boilers DTA 250 User Manual
Canon HJ17EX7 6B User Manual
Dell 17FP User Manual
Focal Polyglass 100 VRS User Manual
GE 169099 User Manual
Hamilton Beach HBH450 User Manual
ION 2 SD User Manual